blob: 87eb5d3beb33b9951974c6449486705c01a7717e [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau1db55792020-11-05 17:20:35 +01005 version 2.4
Willy Tarreauf8e32182023-02-14 16:57:13 +01006 2023/02/14
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007
8
9This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
18 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
19 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020020 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
22 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
23 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020024 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025
26
27Summary
28-------
29
301. Quick reminder about HTTP
311.1. The HTTP transaction model
321.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100331.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200341.2.2. The request headers
351.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100361.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200371.3.2. The response headers
38
392. Configuring HAProxy
402.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200412.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200422.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100432.4. Conditional blocks
442.5. Time format
Daniel Epperson07ff2fb2023-05-15 12:45:27 -0700452.6. Size format
462.7. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020047
483. Global parameters
493.1. Process management and security
503.2. Performance tuning
513.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100523.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200533.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200543.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200553.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100563.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200573.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100583.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
604. Proxies
614.1. Proxy keywords matrix
624.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
63
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100645. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200655.1. Bind options
665.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200675.3. Server DNS resolution
685.3.1. Global overview
695.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100716. Cache
726.1. Limitation
736.2. Setup
746.2.1. Cache section
756.2.2. Proxy section
76
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200777. Using ACLs and fetching samples
787.1. ACL basics
797.1.1. Matching booleans
807.1.2. Matching integers
817.1.3. Matching strings
827.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
837.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
847.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
857.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
867.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200877.3.1. Converters
887.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
897.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
907.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
917.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
927.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200937.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200947.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095
968. Logging
978.1. Log levels
988.2. Log formats
998.2.1. Default log format
1008.2.2. TCP log format
1018.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001028.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001038.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001048.3. Advanced logging options
1058.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1068.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1078.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1088.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1098.4. Timing events
1108.5. Session state at disconnection
1118.6. Non-printable characters
1128.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1138.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1148.9. Examples of logs
115
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001169. Supported filters
1179.1. Trace
1189.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001199.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001209.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001219.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001229.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200123
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012410. FastCGI applications
12510.1. Setup
12610.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12710.1.2. Proxy section
12810.1.3. Example
12910.2. Default parameters
13010.3. Limitations
131
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013211. Address formats
13311.1. Address family prefixes
13411.2. Socket type prefixes
13511.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136
1371. Quick reminder about HTTP
138----------------------------
139
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100140When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200141fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
142on almost anything found in the contents.
143
144However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
145formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
146correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
147
148
1491.1. The HTTP transaction model
150-------------------------------
151
152The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100153to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100154from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
155connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156will involve a new connection :
157
158 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
159
160In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
161establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
162by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
163length.
164
165Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
166to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
167however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
168response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
169header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
170
171 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
172
173Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
174power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
175but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200176a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100178Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
180second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
181page :
182
183 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
184
185This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
186latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
187correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
188the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100189server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100191The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
192time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
193are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
194parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
195carry the stream identifier.
196
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100197By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
198connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
199leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100200start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
201processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
202waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200203
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200204HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100205 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
206 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100207 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100208 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200209 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100210
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100211
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212
2131.2. HTTP request
214-----------------
215
216First, let's consider this HTTP request :
217
218 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100219 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200220 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
221 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
222 3 User-agent: my small browser
223 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
224 5 Accept: image/png
225
226
2271.2.1. The Request line
228-----------------------
229
230Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
231
232 - a METHOD : GET
233 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
234 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
235
236All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
237which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
238followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
239is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
240desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
241the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
242
243The URI itself can have several forms :
244
245 - A "relative URI" :
246
247 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
248
249 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
250 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
251
252 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
253
254 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
255
256 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
257 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
258 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
259 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
260 must accept this form too.
261
262 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
263 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
264 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100265
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200266 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
267 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
268 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
269 other protocols too.
270
271In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
272mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
273on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
274It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
275specific to the language, framework or application in use.
276
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100277HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100278assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100279
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200280
2811.2.2. The request headers
282--------------------------
283
284The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
285beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
286an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
287Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
288values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
289encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
290the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
291define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
292
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100293Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100295"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200296as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
297normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
298representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
299HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200300
301The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
302that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
303is one valid form of empty line.
304
305Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
306headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
307about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
308application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
309
310Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000311 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200312 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
313 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
314 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
315
316
3171.3. HTTP response
318------------------
319
320An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
321messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
322
323 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100324 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200325 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
326 2 Content-length: 350
327 3 Content-Type: text/html
328
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200329As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
330codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
331response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100332continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
333the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
334following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
335sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
336(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
337correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
338such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
339state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400340over the same connection and that HAProxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100341if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
342information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200343
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200344
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003451.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200346------------------------
347
348Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
349
350 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
351 - a status code : 200
352 - a reason : OK
353
354The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100355 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
356 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
357 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
358 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
359 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200360
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000361Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100362"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
364messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
365or "Authentication Required".
366
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100367HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200368
369 Code When / reason
370 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
371 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
372 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
373 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100374 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
375 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200376 400 for an invalid or too large request
377 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
378 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200379 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100380 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100382 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
383 be available again
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400384 500 when HAProxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200385 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400386 501 when HAProxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100387 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200388 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200389 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200390 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
391 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
392 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
393
394The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3954.2).
396
397
3981.3.2. The response headers
399---------------------------
400
401Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
402the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
403details.
404
405
4062. Configuring HAProxy
407----------------------
408
4092.1. Configuration file format
410------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200411
412HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
413
414 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100415 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700416 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100417 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200418
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100419The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
420a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100421
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100422 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
423
424 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
425
426 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
427 tab characters
428
429 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
430 keyword sequences listed in this document
431
432 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
433 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
434 parts of the configuration, or expressions
435
436 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
437 are supported
438
439 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
440 section
441
442This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
443generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
444figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
445
446First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
447the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
448a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
449word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
450follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
451the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
452the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
453the parts that need to be addressed.
454
455A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
456requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
457extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
458the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
459section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
460section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
461not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
462
463A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
464each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
465a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
466start a new one.
467
468Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
469that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
470applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
471"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
472processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
473ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
474which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
475In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
476of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
477identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
478such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4792, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
480
481 listen foo
482 bind :80
483
484 listen bar
485 bind :81
486
487Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
488spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
489of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
490following configurations are strictly equivalent:
491
492 global#this is the global section
493 daemon#daemonize
494 frontend foo
495 mode http # or tcp
496
497and:
498
499 global
500 daemon
501
502 # this is the public web frontend
503 frontend foo
504 mode http
505
506The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
507new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
508other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
509section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
510section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
511at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
512
513Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
514are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
515editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
516support automatic indent.
517
518In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
519positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
520modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
521anymore, and is not recommended.
522
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200523
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005242.2. Quoting and escaping
525-------------------------
526
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100527In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
528that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
529possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
530in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
531('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200532
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100533This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
534very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
535the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
536also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
537delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
538word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
539remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200540
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100541If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
542(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
543
544Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
545backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200546
547 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
548 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
549 \\ to use a backslash
550 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
551 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
552
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100553In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
554C-language representation:
555
556 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
557 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
558 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
559 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
560
561Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
562or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
563of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200564
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100565 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200566 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
567 # hash as a comment start
568
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100569Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
570evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
571dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
572backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200573
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100574Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
575character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
576is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200577
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100578As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
579entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
580name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
581represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
582hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200583
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100584 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
585 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
586 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
587 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
588 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
589 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
590 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
591 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
592 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
593 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
594 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200595
596 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100597 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200598 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
599 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
600 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
601 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
602 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
603
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100604There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
605necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
606by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
607they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
608escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
609characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
610case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
611if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
612own quotes.
613
614The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600615quotes, except that the \#, \$, and \xNN escapes are not processed. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500616not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100617quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
618
619Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
620arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
621
622 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
623 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
624
625Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
626"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
627cannot write:
628
629 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
630
631because we would like the string to cut like this:
632
633 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
634 |---------|----|-|
635 arg1 _/ / /
636 arg2 __________/ /
637 arg3 ______________/
638
639but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
640parenthesis then garbage:
641
642 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
643 |--------|--------|
644 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
645 trailing garbage _________/
646
647The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
648quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
649processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
650this word:
651
652 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
653 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
654 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
655
656So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
657still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
658the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
659the second level:
660
661 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
662 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
663 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
664 |---------||----|-|
665 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
666 arg2=blah ___________/ /
667 arg3=g _______________/
668
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500669Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100670double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
671
672 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
673 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
674 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
675 |---------||----|-|
676 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
677 arg2 ___________/ /
678 arg3 _______________/
679
680When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
681appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
682string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
683thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
684
685 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
686 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
687 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
688 |-------------| |-----||-|
689 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
690 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
691 arg3 ______________________/
692
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400693Remember that backslashes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600694that the whole word above is already protected against them using the single
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100695quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
696single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
697level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
698
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600699Unfortunately, since single quotes can't be escaped inside of strong quoting,
700if you need to include single quotes in your argument, you will need to escape
701or quote them twice. There are a few ways to do this:
702
703 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str("\\'foo\\'")
704 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\"\'foo\'\")
705 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\\\'foo\\\')
706
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100707When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
708double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600709and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash if the string contains
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100710a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
711a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
712the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
713regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
714around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
715more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200716
717
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007182.3. Environment variables
719--------------------------
720
721HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
722interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
723configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
724optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
725shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200726underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
727list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
728arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
729before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200730
731 Example:
732
733 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
734
735 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
736
737 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
738
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200739Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
740file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200741
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200742* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
743 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
744
745* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
746 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
747 directory.
748
749* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
750
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500751* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200752 processes, separated by semicolons.
753
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500754* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200755 CLI, separated by semicolons.
756
William Lallemanda48f51b2023-02-21 14:07:05 +0100757* HAPROXY_STARTUP_VERSION: contains the version used to start, in master-worker
758 mode this is the version which was used to start the master, even after
759 updating the binary and reloading.
760
Willy Tarreaua46f1af2021-05-06 10:25:11 +0200761In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
762regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
763only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
764
765* .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
766
767* .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
768 starting at one.
769
770* .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
771 section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
772 first section.
773
774These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
775if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
776section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
777"log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
778proxies.
779
780This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
781logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
782to name some config objects like servers for example.
783
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200784See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200785
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100786
7872.4. Conditional blocks
788-----------------------
789
790It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
791some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
792ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
793configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
794versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
795preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
796text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
797lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
798switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
799are defined to form conditional blocks:
800
801 - .if <condition>
802 - .elif <condition>
803 - .else
804 - .endif
805
806The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
807as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
808matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
809there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
810only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
811".elif" of a block.
812
813Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
814ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
815as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
816
817The conditions are currently limited to:
818
819 - an empty string, always returns "false"
820 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
821 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200822 - a predicate optionally followed by argument(s) in parenthesis.
823
824The list of currently supported predicates is the following:
825
826 - defined(<name>) : returns true if an environment variable <name>
827 exists, regardless of its contents
828
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200829 - feature(<name>) : returns true if feature <name> is listed as present
830 in the features list reported by "haproxy -vv"
831 (which means a <name> appears after a '+')
832
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200833 - streq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings are equal
834 - strneq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings differ
835
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200836 - version_atleast(<ver>): returns true if the current haproxy version is
837 at least as recent as <ver> otherwise false. The
838 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
839 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
840
841 - version_before(<ver>) : returns true if the current haproxy version is
842 strictly older than <ver> otherwise false. The
843 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
844 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
845
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200846Example:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100847
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200848 .if defined(HAPROXY_MWORKER)
849 listen mwcli_px
850 bind :1111
851 ...
852 .endif
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100853
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200854 .if strneq("$SSL_ONLY",yes)
855 bind :80
856 .endif
857
858 .if streq("$WITH_SSL",yes)
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200859 .if feature(OPENSSL)
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200860 bind :443 ssl crt ...
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200861 .endif
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200862 .endif
863
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200864 .if version_atleast(2.4-dev19)
865 profiling.memory on
866 .endif
867
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200868Four other directives are provided to report some status:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100869
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200870 - .diag "message" : emit this message only when in diagnostic mode (-dD)
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100871 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
872 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
873 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
874
875Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
876"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
877fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
878provide advice to the user.
879
880Example:
881
882 .if "${A}"
883 .if "${B}"
884 .notice "A=1, B=1"
885 .elif "${C}"
886 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
887 .elif "${D}"
888 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
889 .else
890 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
891 .endif
892 .else
893 .notice "A=0"
894 .endif
895
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200896 .diag "WTA/2021-05-07: replace 'redirect' with 'return' after switch to 2.4"
897 http-request redirect location /goaway if ABUSE
898
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100899
9002.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200901----------------
902
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100903Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100904values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
905otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
906numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
907for every keyword. Supported units are :
908
909 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
910 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
911 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
912 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
913 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
914 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
915
916
Daniel Epperson07ff2fb2023-05-15 12:45:27 -07009172.6. Size format
918----------------
919
920Some parameters involve values representing size, such as bandwidth limits.
921These values are generally expressed in bytes (unless explicitly stated
922otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
923numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
924for every keyword. Supported units are case insensitive :
925
926 - k : kilobytes. 1 kilobyte = 1024 bytes
927 - m : megabytes. 1 megabyte = 1048576 bytes
928 - g : gigabytes. 1 gigabyte = 1073741824 bytes
929
930Both time and size formats require integers, decimal notation is not allowed.
931
932
9332.7. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200934-------------
935
936 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
937 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
938 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
939 global
940 daemon
941 maxconn 256
942
943 defaults
944 mode http
945 timeout connect 5000ms
946 timeout client 50000ms
947 timeout server 50000ms
948
949 frontend http-in
950 bind *:80
951 default_backend servers
952
953 backend servers
954 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
955
956
957 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
958 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
959 global
960 daemon
961 maxconn 256
962
963 defaults
964 mode http
965 timeout connect 5000ms
966 timeout client 50000ms
967 timeout server 50000ms
968
969 listen http-in
970 bind *:80
971 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
972
973
974Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
975
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100976 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200977
978
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009793. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200980--------------------
981
982Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
983are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
984of them have command-line equivalents.
985
986The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
987
988 * Process management and security
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100989 - 51degrees-cache-size
990 - 51degrees-data-file
991 - 51degrees-property-name-list
992 - 51degrees-property-separator
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200993 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200994 - chroot
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200995 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100996 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200997 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +0200998 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200999 - description
1000 - deviceatlas-json-file
1001 - deviceatlas-log-level
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001002 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001003 - deviceatlas-separator
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001004 - expose-experimental-directives
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001005 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001006 - gid
1007 - group
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001008 - h1-case-adjust
1009 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001010 - h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
1011 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001012 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001013 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001014 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001015 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001016 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001017 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001018 - log-tag
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001019 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001020 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001021 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001022 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001023 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001024 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001025 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001026 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001027 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001028 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001029 - presetenv
1030 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001031 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001032 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001033 - setenv
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001034 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001035 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001036 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001037 - ssl-default-bind-options
1038 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001039 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001040 - ssl-default-server-options
1041 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001042 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001043 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001044 - stats
1045 - strict-limits
1046 - uid
1047 - ulimit-n
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001048 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001049 - unsetenv
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001050 - user
1051 - wurfl-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001052 - wurfl-data-file
1053 - wurfl-information-list
1054 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001055
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001056 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +01001057 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001058 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001059 - maxcompcpuusage
1060 - maxcomprate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001061 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001062 - maxconnrate
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001063 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001064 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001065 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001066 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001067 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau85dd5212022-03-08 10:41:40 +01001068 - no-memory-trimming
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001069 - noepoll
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001070 - noevports
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001071 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001072 - nokqueue
1073 - nopoll
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001074 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001075 - nosplice
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001076 - profiling.tasks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001077 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001078 - server-state-file
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001079 - spread-checks
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001080 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001081 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001082 - tune.buffers.limit
1083 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001084 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001085 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001086 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Christopher Faulet48110bc2023-02-20 14:33:46 +01001087 - tune.fail-alloc
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001088 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001089 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001090 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001091 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001092 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001093 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001094 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001095 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001096 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001097 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001098 - tune.lua.maxmem
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001099 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001100 - tune.lua.session-timeout
1101 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001102 - tune.maxaccept
1103 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001104 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001105 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001106 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001107 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1108 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001109 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1110 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001111 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001112 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001113 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001114 - tune.sndbuf.client
1115 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001116 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001117 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
1118 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
1119 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001120 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001121 - tune.ssl.lifetime
1122 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001123 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001124 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001125 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001126 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1127 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1128 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001129 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1130 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001131
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001132 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001133 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001134 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001135
1136
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011373.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001138------------------------------------
1139
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100114051degrees-data-file <file path>
1141 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
1142 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1143
1144 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
1145 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1146
114751degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
1148 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1149 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1150 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1151
1152 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
1153 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1154
115551degrees-property-separator <char>
1156 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1157 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1158
1159 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
1160 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1161
116251degrees-cache-size <number>
1163 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1164 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1165 By default, this cache is disabled.
1166
1167 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
1168 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1169
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001170ca-base <dir>
1171 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001172 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1173 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1174 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001175
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001176chroot <jail dir>
1177 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1178 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1179 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1180 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1181 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001182 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001183
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001184cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
1185 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
1186 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
1187 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
1188 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
1189 set. These sets have the format
1190
1191 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1192
1193 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001194 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001195 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
1196 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001197 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
1198 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Amaury Denoyelle982fb532021-04-21 18:39:58 +02001199 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the first
1200 CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Outside of
1201 Linux and BSDs, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to either
1202 31 or 63. Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes
1203 or threads will be allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple
1204 "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace
1205 the previous ones when they overlap. A thread will be bound on the
1206 intersection of its mapping and the one of the process on which it is
1207 attached. If the intersection is null, no specific binding will be set for
1208 the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001209
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001210 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1211 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1212 on the machine's word size.
1213
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001214 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001215 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
1216 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
1217 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
1218 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
1219 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
1220 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001221
1222 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001223 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
1224
1225 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1226 # first 4 CPUs
1227
1228 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
1229 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
1230 # word size.
1231
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001232 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001233 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001234 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
1235 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
1236 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
1237
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001238 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1239 # and so on.
1240 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1241 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1242 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1243
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001244 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001245 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
1246 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
1247 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
1248
1249 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
1250 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
1251 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
1252
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001253 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
1254 # and a thread range.
1255 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
1256 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
1257 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
1258
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001259crt-base <dir>
1260 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001261 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1262 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001263
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001264daemon
1265 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1266 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001267 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1268 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001269
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001270default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001271 By default HAProxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001272 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1273 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1274 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1275 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1276 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1277 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1278 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1279 not start with a slash ('/'):
1280 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1281 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1282
1283 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1284 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1285 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1286 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1287 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1288 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1289 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1290 each of them.
1291
1292 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1293 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1294 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1295 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1296 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1297 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1298 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1299 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1300
1301 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1302 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001303 different HAProxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001304 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1305 made easily relocatable.
1306
1307 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1308 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1309 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1310 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1311 consistent across all configuration files.
1312
1313 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1314 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1315 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1316 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1317 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1318 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1319 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1320 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1321
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001322description <text>
1323 Add a text that describes the instance.
1324
1325 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1326 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1327 "<" and ">" characters.
1328
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001329deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1330 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001331 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001332
1333deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001334 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001335 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1336
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001337deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001338 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1339 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1340 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001341
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001342deviceatlas-separator <char>
1343 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1344 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1345
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001346expose-experimental-directives
1347 This statement must appear before using directives tagged as experimental or
1348 the config file will be rejected.
1349
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001350external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001351 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1352 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001353 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1354 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1355 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1356 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1357 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001358
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001359gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001360 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001361 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1362 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001363 Note that if HAProxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001364 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001365 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001366
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001367group <group name>
1368 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1369 See also "gid" and "user".
1370
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001371h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1372 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1373 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1374 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1375 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001376 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001377 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1378 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1379 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1380 specified in a proxy.
1381
1382 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1383 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1384 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1385 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1386 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1387 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1388 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1389
1390 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1391 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1392 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1393 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1394 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1395
1396 Example:
1397 global
1398 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1399
1400 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1401 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1402
1403h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1404 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1405 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1406 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1407 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1408 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1409 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1410 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1411 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1412
1413 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1414 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1415 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1416
1417 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1418 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1419
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001420h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
1421 This disables the announcement of the support for h2 websockets to clients.
1422 This can be use to overcome clients which have issues when implementing the
1423 relatively fresh RFC8441, such as Firefox 88. To allow clients to
1424 automatically downgrade to http/1.1 for the websocket tunnel, specify h2
1425 support on the bind line using "alpn" without an explicit "proto" keyword. If
1426 this statement was previously activated, this can be disabled by prefixing
1427 the keyword with "no'.
1428
1429hard-stop-after <time>
1430 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1431
1432 Arguments :
1433 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1434 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1435 SIGUSR1 signal.
1436
1437 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1438 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1439 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1440
1441 Example:
1442 global
1443 hard-stop-after 30s
1444
1445 See also: grace
1446
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001447insecure-fork-wanted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001448 By default HAProxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001449 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1450 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1451 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1452 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1453 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1454 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1455 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001456 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within HAProxy itself
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001457 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1458 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1459 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1460 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1461 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1462 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1463 disable it.
1464
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001465insecure-setuid-wanted
1466 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1467 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1468 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1469 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001470 aware of the risks. In a situation where HAProxy would need to call external
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001471 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001472 HAProxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001473 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1474 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001475 escalation in such a situation. This is what HAProxy does by default. In case
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001476 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1477 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1478 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1479 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1480
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001481issuers-chain-path <dir>
1482 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1483 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1484 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001485 intermediate certificate), HAProxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001486 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1487 "issuers-chain-path".
1488 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1489 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1490 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1491 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1492 will share the chain in memory.
1493
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001494localpeer <name>
1495 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1496 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1497 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1498 the configuration parsing.
1499
1500 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1501 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1502
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001503log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001504 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001505 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001506 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001507 configured with "log global".
1508
1509 <address> can be one of:
1510
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001511 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001512 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1513 port).
1514
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001515 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1516 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1517 port).
1518
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001519 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001520 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1521 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001522 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001523
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001524 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1525 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1526 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1527 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1528 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1529 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1530 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1531 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1532 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1533 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001534 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow HAProxy down
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001535 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1536 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1537 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001538 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1539 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001540
1541 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1542 "fd@2", see above.
1543
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001544 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1545 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1546 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1547 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1548 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1549
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001550 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1551 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001552
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001553 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1554 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1555 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1556 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1557 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1558 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1559 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1560 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1561 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1562 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001563 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1564 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001565
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001566 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1567 one of the following :
1568
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001569 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1570 field is stripped. This is the default.
1571 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1572 rfc3164.
1573
1574 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001575 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1576
1577 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1578 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1579
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001580 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1581 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1582 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1583 designed to be used with a local log server.
1584
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001585 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1586 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1587 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1588 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1589 logger consumes.
1590
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001591 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1592 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1593 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1594 used with a local log server.
1595
1596 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1597 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1598 designed to be used with a local log server.
1599
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001600 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1601 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1602 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1603 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1604
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001605 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1606 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1607 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1608 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1609 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1610
1611 <sample_size>
1612 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1613 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1614 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1615 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1616 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1617
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001618 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001619
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001620 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1621 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1622 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1623
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001624 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1625 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1626 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1627 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001628
1629 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001630 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1631 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1632 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1633 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1634 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1635 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001636
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001637 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001638
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001639log-send-hostname [<string>]
1640 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1641 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1642 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1643 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1644 the logs.
1645
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001646log-tag <string>
1647 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1648 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1649 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001650 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001651
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001652lua-load <file>
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001653 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1654 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1655 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1656 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1657 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1658 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001659 used multiple times.
1660
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001661lua-load-per-thread <file>
1662 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1663 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1664 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1665 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1666 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1667 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1668 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1669 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1670 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1671 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1672 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1673 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1674 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1675 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1676 times.
1677
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001678lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1679 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1680 variable.
1681 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1682 to "path".
1683
1684 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1685 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1686 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1687 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1688 will be checked earlier.
1689
1690 As an example by specifying the following path:
1691
1692 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1693 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1694
1695 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1696 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1697 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1698 paths if that does not exist either.
1699
1700 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1701 documentation.
1702
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001703master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001704 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1705 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1706 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001707 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001708 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1709 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001710 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1711 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1712 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1713 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1714 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001715
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001716 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001717
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001718mworker-max-reloads <number>
1719 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001720 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001721 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1722 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1723 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1724
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001725nbproc <number> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001726 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1727 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1728 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001729 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1730 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001731 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. This directive is deprecated
1732 and scheduled for removal in 2.5. Please use "nbthread" instead. See also
1733 "daemon" and "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001734
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001735nbthread <number>
1736 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001737 makes HAProxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001738 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1739 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1740 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1741 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001742 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1743 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1744 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1745 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1746 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1747 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1748 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001749
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001750numa-cpu-mapping
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001751 By default, if running on Linux, HAProxy inspects on startup the CPU topology
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001752 of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity is
1753 automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done in
1754 order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the inter-socket
1755 bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a particular
1756 architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no numa-cpu-mapping'.
1757 This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread statement is present
1758 in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is already specified,
1759 for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset utility.
1760
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001761pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001762 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1763 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1764 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1765 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001766
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001767pp2-never-send-local
1768 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1769 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1770 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1771 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1772 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1773 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1774 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1775 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1776 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1777 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1778 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1779
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001780presetenv <name> <value>
1781 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1782 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1783 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1784 and "unsetenv".
1785
1786resetenv [<name> ...]
1787 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1788 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1789 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1790 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1791 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1792 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1793 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1794 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1795
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001796stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001797 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1798 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1799 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1800 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1801 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1802 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001803 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001804 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1805 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1806 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1807 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001808
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001809server-state-base <directory>
1810 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001811 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1812 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001813
1814server-state-file <file>
1815 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1816 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1817 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1818 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1819 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1820 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1821 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1822 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001823 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1824 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001825
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001826set-dumpable
1827 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
1828 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1829 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1830 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1831 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1832 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1833 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1834 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1835 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1836 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1837 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1838 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1839 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1840 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1841 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1842 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1843 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the "haproxy" process and verify that it
1844 leaves a core where expected when dying.
1845
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001846set-var <var-name> <expr>
1847 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
1848 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1849 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1850 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
1851 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
1852 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
1853 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It's is
1854 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
1855 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1856
1857 Example:
1858 global
1859 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
1860 set-var proc.prio int(100)
1861 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
1862
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001863setenv <name> <value>
1864 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1865 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1866 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1867 and "unsetenv".
1868
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001869ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1870 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1871 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001872 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001873 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001874 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1875 information and recommendations see e.g.
1876 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1877 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1878 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1879 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001880
1881ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1882 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1883 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1884 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1885 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1886 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001887 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1888 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1889 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001890 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001891
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001892ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1893 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1894 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1895 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1896 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1897 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1898
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001899ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1900 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1901 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1902 keyword to see available options.
1903
1904 Example:
1905 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001906 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001907
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001908ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1909 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1910 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001911 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001912 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001913 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1914 information and recommendations see e.g.
1915 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1916 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1917 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1918 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1919 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001920
1921ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1922 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1923 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1924 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1925 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1926 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001927 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1928 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1929 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1930 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001931
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001932ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1933 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1934 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1935 keyword to see available options.
1936
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001937ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1938 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1939 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1940 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001941 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001942 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001943 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1944 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1945 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1946 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001947 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1948 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1949 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1950
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001951ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1952 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1953 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001954 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001955 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001956 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1957
1958 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001959
1960 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1961 and won't try to remove them.
1962
1963 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1964
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001965ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001966 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001967 the loading of the SSL certificates. This option applies to certificates
1968 associated to "bind" lines as well as "server" lines but some of the extra
1969 files will not have any functional impact for "server" line certificates.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001970
1971 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1972 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1973 optimize the startup time.
1974
1975 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1976 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1977 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1978
1979 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001980 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001981
1982 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001983 will try to load a "cert bundle". Certificate bundles are only managed on the
1984 frontend side and will not work for backend certificates.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001985
1986 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1987 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1988 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1989 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1990 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001991 bind configuration.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001992
1993 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001994 HAProxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001995 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1996 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1997 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1998 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1999 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002000 this bundle into HAProxy, specify the base name only:
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002001
2002 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
2003
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002004 Note that the suffix is not given to HAProxy; this tells HAProxy to look for
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002005 a cert bundle.
2006
2007 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
2008 separately in several "crt".
2009
2010 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
2011 since files are loading separately.
2012
2013 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
2014 required to commit them.
2015
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02002016 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002017 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002018
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002019 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2020 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2021 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002022
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002023 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2024 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2025 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002026
2027 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002028 not provided in the PEM file. If provided for a backend certificate, it will
2029 be loaded but will not have any functional impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002030
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002031 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
2032 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
2033
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002034 The default behavior is "all".
2035
2036 Example:
2037 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
2038 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
2039 ssl-load-extra-files none
2040
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002041 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options and section 5.2 about server
2042 options.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002043
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01002044ssl-server-verify [none|required]
2045 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
2046 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
2047 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
2048
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002049ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002050 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002051 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
2052 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
2053 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
2054 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
2055 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
2056 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02002057 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002058
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002059stats maxconn <connections>
2060 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
2061 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
2062
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002063stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
2064 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
2065 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
2066 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02002067 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02002068 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02002069
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002070 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
2071 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
2072 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002073
2074stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
2075 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
2076 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01002077 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002078
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002079strict-limits
2080 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. HAProxy tries to set the
2081 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2082 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
2083 HAProxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
2084 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002085
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002086uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07002087 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002088 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
2089 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
2090 one. See also "gid" and "user".
2091
2092ulimit-n <number>
2093 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
2094 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
2095 option.
2096
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002097unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
2098 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
2099
2100 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
2101 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
2102 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
2103 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
2104 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002105 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before HAProxy chroots
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002106 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
2107 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
2108 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
2109 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
2110
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002111unsetenv [<name> ...]
2112 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
2113 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
2114 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
2115 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
2116 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
2117 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
2118 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
2119
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002120user <user name>
2121 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2122 See also "uid" and "group".
2123
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02002124node <name>
2125 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
2126
2127 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
2128 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
2129 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
2130 traffic.
2131
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002132wurfl-cache-size <size>
2133 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2134 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
2135 - "0" : no cache is used.
2136 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002137
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002138 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
2139 with USE_WURFL=1.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002140
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002141wurfl-data-file <file path>
2142 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2143 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2144
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002145 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002146 with USE_WURFL=1.
2147
2148wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2149 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2150 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2151 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2152
2153 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2154
2155 Valid WURFL properties are:
2156 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2157
2158 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2159 device.
2160
2161 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2162 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2163
2164 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2165 particular web request.
2166
2167 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2168 used Libwurfl API version.
2169
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002170 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2171 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2172
2173 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2174 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2175
2176 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2177
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002178 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002179 with USE_WURFL=1.
2180
2181wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2182 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2183 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2184
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002185 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002186 with USE_WURFL=1.
2187
2188wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2189 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2190 thus before the chroot.
2191
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002192 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002193 with USE_WURFL=1.
2194
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021953.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002196-----------------------
2197
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002198busy-polling
2199 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2200 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2201 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2202 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2203 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2204 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2205 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2206 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2207 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2208 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2209 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2210 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2211 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2212 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2213 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2214 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2215 "poll" pollers.
2216
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002217 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2218 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2219 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2220
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002221max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002222 By default, HAProxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002223 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2224 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2225 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2226 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2227 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2228 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2229 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2230
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002231maxcompcpuusage <number>
2232 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2233 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2234 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
2235 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by HAProxy. A
2236 value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting a lower
2237 value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole process down
2238 and from introducing high latencies.
2239
2240maxcomprate <number>
2241 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
2242 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
2243 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2244 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2245 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
2246 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
2247 default value.
2248
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002249maxconn <number>
2250 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2251 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2252 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002253 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2254 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2255 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2256 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002257 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2258 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2259 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2260 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2261 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
2262 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002263
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002264maxconnrate <number>
2265 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2266 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2267 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2268 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2269 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2270 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2271 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2272 fairness.
2273
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002274maxpipes <number>
2275 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2276 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2277 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2278 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2279 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2280 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2281
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002282maxsessrate <number>
2283 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2284 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2285 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2286 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2287 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2288 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2289 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2290 fairness.
2291
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002292maxsslconn <number>
2293 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2294 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2295 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2296 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2297 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2298 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2299 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002300 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2301 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2302 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2303 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002304 when there is a memory limit, HAProxy will automatically adjust these values
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002305 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2306 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002307
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002308maxsslrate <number>
2309 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2310 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2311 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2312 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2313 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2314 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2315 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2316 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2317 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2318 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2319
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002320maxzlibmem <number>
2321 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2322 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2323 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002324 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2325 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2326 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2327
Willy Tarreau85dd5212022-03-08 10:41:40 +01002328no-memory-trimming
2329 Disables memory trimming ("malloc_trim") at a few moments where attempts are
2330 made to reclaim lots of memory (on memory shortage or on reload). Trimming
2331 memory forces the system's allocator to scan all unused areas and to release
2332 them. This is generally seen as nice action to leave more available memory to
2333 a new process while the old one is unlikely to make significant use of it.
2334 But some systems dealing with tens to hundreds of thousands of concurrent
2335 connections may experience a lot of memory fragmentation, that may render
2336 this release operation extremely long. During this time, no more traffic
2337 passes through the process, new connections are not accepted anymore, some
2338 health checks may even fail, and the watchdog may even trigger and kill the
2339 unresponsive process, leaving a huge core dump. If this ever happens, then it
2340 is suggested to use this option to disable trimming and stop trying to be
2341 nice with the new process. Note that advanced memory allocators usually do
2342 not suffer from such a problem.
2343
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002344noepoll
2345 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2346 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002347 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002348
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002349noevports
2350 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2351 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2352 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2353 also "nopoll".
2354
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002355nogetaddrinfo
2356 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2357 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2358
2359nokqueue
2360 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2361 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2362 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2363
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002364nopoll
2365 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2366 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002367 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002368 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2369 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002370
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002371noreuseport
2372 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2373 command line argument "-dR".
2374
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002375nosplice
2376 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002377 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002378 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002379 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002380 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2381 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2382 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2383 "option splice-response".
2384
Willy Tarreauca3afc22021-05-05 18:33:19 +02002385profiling.memory { on | off }
2386 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
2387 keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
2388 process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
2389 "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
2390 abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
2391 other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
2392 maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
2393 use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
2394 "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
2395
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002396profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2397 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2398 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2399 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2400 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002401 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002402 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2403 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2404 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2405 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2406
2407 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2408 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2409 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2410 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2411 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002412 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2413 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2414 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2415 CLI.
2416
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002417spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002418 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2419 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2420 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2421 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2422 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2423 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002424
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002425ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002426 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002427 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002428 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002429 unsupported engine will prevent HAProxy from starting. Note that many engines
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002430 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2431 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2432 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002433 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2434 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002435 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2436 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2437 openssl configuration file uses:
2438 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2439
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002440ssl-mode-async
2441 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002442 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002443 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2444 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002445 HAProxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002446 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002447 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002448
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002449tune.buffers.limit <number>
2450 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2451 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2452 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2453 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2454 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002455 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002456 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2457 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2458 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2459 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2460 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2461 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2462 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2463 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002464 advised to do so by an HAProxy core developer.
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002465
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002466tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2467 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2468 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2469 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002470 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at HAProxy core developers.
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002471
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002472tune.bufsize <number>
2473 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2474 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2475 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2476 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2477 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2478 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2479 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002480 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2481 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002482 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), HAProxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002483 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002484 than this size, HAProxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002485 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2486 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002487
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01002488tune.chksize <number> (deprecated)
2489 This option is deprecated and ignored.
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02002490
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002491tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2492 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2493 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2494 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2495 this value. The default value is 1.
2496
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002497tune.fail-alloc
2498 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2499 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2500 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2501 gracefully.
2502
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002503tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2504 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2505 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2506 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2507 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2508 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2509
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002510tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2511 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2512 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2513 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2514 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2515 change it.
2516
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002517tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2518 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002519 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from HAProxy. This setting
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002520 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002521 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2522 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2523 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2524 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2525 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2526
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002527tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2528 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2529 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2530 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2531 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2532 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002533 client may create as many streams as allocatable by HAProxy. It is highly
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002534 recommended not to change this value.
2535
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002536tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002537 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that HAProxy announces it is willing to
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002538 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002539 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, HAProxy will not announce support
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002540 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2541 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2542 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2543 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2544
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002545tune.http.cookielen <number>
2546 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2547 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2548 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2549 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2550 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2551 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2552 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2553 to change this value.
2554
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002555tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002556 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2557 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002558 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002559 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002560 configuration directives too.
2561 The default value is 1024.
2562
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002563tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2564 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2565 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2566 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2567 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2568 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2569 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002570 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2571 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2572 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002573
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002574tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2575 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2576 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2577 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2578 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2579 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2580 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002581 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2582 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2583 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2584 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2585 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002586
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002587tune.idletimer <timeout>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002588 Sets the duration after which HAProxy will consider that an empty buffer is
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002589 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2590 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2591 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2592 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002593 means that HAProxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002594 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002595 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002596 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2597
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002598tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2599 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2600 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2601 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2602 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2603 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2604 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2605 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2606 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2607 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2608
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002609tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2610 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002611 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002612 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2613 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002614 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002615 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2616 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2617
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002618tune.lua.maxmem
2619 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2620 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2621 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2622 memory.
2623
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002624tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2625 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002626 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2627 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002628 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002629
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002630tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2631 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2632 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2633 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002634 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002635
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002636tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2637 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2638 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2639 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2640 check servers.
2641
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002642tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002643 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2644 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01002645 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
2646 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
2647 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
2648 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
2649 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
2650 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
2651 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
2652 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
2653 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002654
2655tune.maxpollevents <number>
2656 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2657 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2658 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2659 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2660 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2661
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002662tune.maxrewrite <number>
2663 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2664 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2665 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2666 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2667 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2668 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2669 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2670 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2671 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2672 bufsize.
2673
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002674tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2675 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2676 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2677 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2678 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2679 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2680 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2681 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2682 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2683 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002684 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2685 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002686 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2687 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2688 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2689 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2690 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2691 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2692 setting this parameter to 0.
2693
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002694tune.pipesize <number>
2695 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2696 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2697 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2698 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2699 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2700 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2701
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002702tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2703 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002704 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002705 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2706 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2707 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2708 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002709 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002710
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002711tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2712 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002713 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002714 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2715 default is 20.
2716
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002717tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2718tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2719 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2720 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2721 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002722 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002723 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002724 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2725 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2726
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002727tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002728 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002729 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2730 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2731 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2732 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2733
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002734tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002735 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01002736 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
2737 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
2738 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
2739 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
2740 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2741 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
2742 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002743
2744tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2745 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002746 HAProxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002747 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2748 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2749 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2750 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2751 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2752 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2753 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002754
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002755tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2756tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2757 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2758 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2759 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002760 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002761 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002762 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2763 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2764 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2765 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002766 notifying HAProxy again.
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002767
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002768tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002769 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01002770 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
2771 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
2772 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
2773 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
2774 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
2775 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
2776 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
2777 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
2778 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
2779 pre-allocated upon startup and are shared between all processes if "nbproc"
2780 is greater than 1. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002781
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002782tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2783 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client hello cipher
2784 list, extensions list, elliptic curves list and elliptic curve point
2785 formats. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled,
2786 otherwise a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2787
2788tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2789 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2790 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2791 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2792 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
2793 this maximum value. Only 1024 or higher values are allowed. Higher values
2794 will increase the CPU load, and values greater than 1024 bits are not
2795 supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not used if static
2796 Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly in the certificate
2797 file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
2798 If there is neither a default-dh-param nor a ssl-dh-param-file defined, and
2799 if the server's PEM file of a given frontend does not specify its own DH
2800 parameters, then DHE ciphers will be unavailable for this frontend.
2801
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002802tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002803 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002804 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2805 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2806 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2807 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2808 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2809
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002810tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2811 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2812 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2813 performances. This is disabled by default.
2814
2815 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2816 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2817
2818 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2819
2820 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2821
2822 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2823
2824 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2825 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2826 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2827
2828 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2829 converted.
2830
2831 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2832 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2833 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2834 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2835 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2836 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2837 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002838 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2839 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002840
2841 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2842
2843 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2844 only need this line:
2845
2846 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2847
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002848tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2849 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002850 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002851 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2852 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2853 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2854 being used for too long.
2855
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002856tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2857 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2858 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2859 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2860 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2861 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2862 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2863 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2864 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2865 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2866 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002867 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002868 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002869
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002870tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2871 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2872 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2873 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2874 1000 entries.
2875
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002876tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002877tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002878tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2879tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2880tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002881 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2882 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2883 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2884 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2885 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2886 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2887 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2888 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002889
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002890 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2891 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2892 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2893 all available space is consumed.
2894 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2895 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2896 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002897
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002898tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2899 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002900 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002901 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002902 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002903 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2904
2905tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2906 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2907 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002908 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2909 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002910
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020029113.3. Debugging
2912--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002913
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002914quiet
2915 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2916 line argument "-q".
2917
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002918zero-warning
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002919 When this option is set, HAProxy will refuse to start if any warning was
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002920 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2921 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2922 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2923 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2924 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2925
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002926
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010029273.4. Userlists
2928--------------
2929It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2930http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2931it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2932
2933userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002934 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002935 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2936
2937group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002938 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002939 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2940 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2941
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002942user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2943 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002944 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2945 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002946 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2947 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2948 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2949 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002950
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002951 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2952 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2953 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2954 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2955 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2956 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2957 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002958 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in HAProxy's
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002959 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002960
2961 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002962 userlist L1
2963 group G1 users tiger,scott
2964 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002965
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002966 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2967 user scott insecure-password elgato
2968 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002969
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002970 userlist L2
2971 group G1
2972 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002973
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002974 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2975 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2976 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002977
2978 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002979
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002980
29813.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002982----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002983It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002984several HAProxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002985instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2986values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2987automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2988In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2989using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2990tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2991reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2992Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2993that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2994each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002995
2996peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002997 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002998 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2999
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003000bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3001 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
3002 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
3003
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003004disabled
3005 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
3006 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
3007 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
3008
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003009default-bind [param*]
3010 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
3011
3012default-server [param*]
3013 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
3014
3015 Arguments:
3016 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3017 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
Willy Tarreaufd5d0e82022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003018 section dedicated to it. In a peers section, the transport
3019 parameters of a "default-server" line are supported. Please refer
3020 to section 5 for more details, and the "server" keyword below in
3021 this section for some of the restrictions.
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003022
3023 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
3024
Emeric Brun7214dcf2021-09-29 10:29:52 +02003025enabled
3026 This re-enables a peers section which was previously disabled via the
3027 "disabled" keyword.
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003028
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003029log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01003030 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3031 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
3032 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
3033 more details.
3034
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003035peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003036 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
3037 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003038 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003039 HAProxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003040 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
3041 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
3042 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003043
3044 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
3045 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
3046
3047 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003048 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
3049 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
3050 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003051
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003052 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
3053 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003054
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003055 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
3056 "server" keyword explanation below).
3057
3058server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003059 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Willy Tarreaufd5d0e82022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003060 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph that are
3061 related to transport settings. If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port>
3062 parameters must not be present; these parameters must be provided on a "bind"
3063 line (see "bind" keyword of this "peers" section).
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003064
Willy Tarreaufd5d0e82022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003065 A number of "server" parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections. Peers by
3066 nature do not support dynamic host name resolution nor health checks, hence
3067 parameters like "init_addr", "resolvers", "check", "agent-check", or "track"
3068 are not supported. Similarly, there is no load balancing nor stickiness, thus
3069 parameters such as "weight" or "cookie" have no effect.
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003070
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003071 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003072 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003073 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003074 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
3075 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3076 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003077
3078 backend mybackend
3079 mode tcp
3080 balance roundrobin
3081 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
3082 stick on src
3083
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003084 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3085 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003086
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003087 Example:
3088 peers mypeers
Emeric Brun6ca8ba42022-05-30 18:13:35 +02003089 bind 192.168.0.1:1024 ssl crt mycerts/pem
3090 default-server ssl verify none
3091 server haproxy1 #local peer
3092 server haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3093 server haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003094
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003095
3096table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
3097 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
3098
3099 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
3100 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003101 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003102 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
3103 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
3104 "stick-table" keyword).
3105
3106 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
3107 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
3108 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
3109 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
3110 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
3111 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
3112 of the stick-table name as follows:
3113
3114 peers mypeers
3115 peer A ...
3116 peer B ...
3117 table t1 ...
3118
3119 frontend fe1
3120 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
3121
3122 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
3123 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
3124
3125 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
3126 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
3127 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
3128 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
3129 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
3130 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
3131 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
3132
3133 peers mypeers
3134 peer A ...
3135 peer B ...
3136 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
3137
3138 backend t1
3139 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
3140
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003141 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003142 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
3143 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
3144
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090031453.6. Mailers
3146------------
3147It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
3148If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
3149in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
3150
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02003151mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003152 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
3153 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
3154
3155mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
3156 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
3157
3158 Example:
3159 mailers mymailers
3160 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
3161 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
3162
3163 backend mybackend
3164 mode tcp
3165 balance roundrobin
3166
3167 email-alert mailers mymailers
3168 email-alert from test1@horms.org
3169 email-alert to test2@horms.org
3170
3171 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3172 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
3173
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01003174timeout mail <time>
3175 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
3176 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
3177 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
3178 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
3179
3180 Example:
3181 mailers mymailers
3182 timeout mail 20s
3183 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003184
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020031853.7. Programs
3186-------------
3187In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
3188master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
3189managed the same way as the workers.
3190
3191During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
3192sequence as a worker:
3193
3194 - the master is re-executed
3195 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
3196 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
3197 instance of the program
3198
3199During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
3200
3201program <name>
3202 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
3203 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
3204 the management guide).
3205
3206command <command> [arguments*]
3207 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
3208 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
3209 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
3210 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
3211
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08003212user <user name>
3213 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
3214 See also "group".
3215
3216group <group name>
3217 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
3218 See also "user".
3219
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02003220option start-on-reload
3221no option start-on-reload
3222 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
3223 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
3224 program section.
3225
3226
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010032273.8. HTTP-errors
3228----------------
3229
3230It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
3231imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
3232several places and can be fully or partially imported.
3233
3234http-errors <name>
3235 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
3236 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
3237
3238errorfile <code> <file>
3239 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
3240
3241 Arguments :
3242 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003243 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01003244 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003245
3246 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
3247 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
3248 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
3249 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3250 before any chroot is performed.
3251
3252 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3253
3254 Example:
3255 http-errors website-1
3256 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3257 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3258 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3259
3260 http-errors website-2
3261 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3262 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3263 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3264
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020032653.9. Rings
3266----------
3267
3268It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3269servers or traces.
3270
3271ring <ringname>
3272 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3273
3274description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003275 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003276 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3277
3278format <format>
3279 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3280
3281 Arguments:
3282 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3283 one of the following :
3284
3285 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3286 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3287 designed to be used with a local log server.
3288
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003289 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3290 field is stripped. This is the default.
3291 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3292 rfc3164.
3293
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003294 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3295 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3296 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3297 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3298 is the default.
3299
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003300 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003301 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3302
3303 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3304 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3305
3306 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3307 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3308 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3309 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3310 logger consumes.
3311
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003312 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3313 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3314 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3315 with a local log server.
3316
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003317 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3318 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3319 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3320 used with a local log server.
3321
3322maxlen <length>
3323 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3324 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3325 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3326
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003327server <name> <address> [param*]
3328 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3329 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3330 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3331 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3332 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3333 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3334 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3335 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3336 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003337 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3338 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003339
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003340size <size>
3341 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3342 set to BUFSIZE.
3343
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003344timeout connect <timeout>
3345 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3346
3347 Arguments :
3348 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3349 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3350 as explained at the top of this document.
3351
3352timeout server <timeout>
3353 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3354
3355 Arguments :
3356 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3357 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3358 as explained at the top of this document.
3359
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003360 Example:
3361 global
3362 log ring@myring local7
3363
3364 ring myring
3365 description "My local buffer"
3366 format rfc3164
3367 maxlen 1200
3368 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003369 timeout connect 5s
3370 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003371 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003372
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020033733.10. Log forwarding
3374-------------------
3375
3376It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003377HAProxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003378
3379log-forward <name>
3380 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3381
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003382backlog <conns>
3383 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3384 on connections accept.
3385
3386bind <addr> [param*]
3387 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003388 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3389 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3390 syslog protocol over TCP.
3391 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003392 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3393
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003394dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003395 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3396 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3397 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3398 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003399 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003400
3401log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003402log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003403 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3404 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3405 documentation.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003406 If no format specified, HAProxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003407 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3408 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3409 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003410 exists in output format, HAProxy will use the local date.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003411
3412 Example:
3413 global
3414 log stderr format iso local7
3415
3416 ring myring
3417 description "My local buffer"
3418 format rfc5424
3419 maxlen 1200
3420 size 32764
3421 timeout connect 5s
3422 timeout server 10s
3423 # syslog tcp server
3424 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3425
3426 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003427 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3428 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003429 # all messages on stderr
3430 log global
3431 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3432 log ring@myring local0
3433 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3434 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3435 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3436 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3437 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003438
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003439maxconn <conns>
3440 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3441 10 is the default.
3442
3443timeout client <timeout>
3444 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3445
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020034464. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003447----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003448
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003449Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003450 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
3451 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3452 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3453 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003454
3455A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3456connections.
3457
3458A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3459to forward incoming connections.
3460
3461A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3462parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3463
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003464A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
3465ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
3466sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
3467the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
3468explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
3469from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
3470"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
3471for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
3472to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
3473optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
3474are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
3475any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
3476names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
3477that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
3478duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
3479names. This rule might be enforced in a future version.
3480
3481Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
3482settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
3483of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
3484profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
3485timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
3486
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003487All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3488'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3489case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3490
3491Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3492logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3493proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3494However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3495name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3496
3497Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3498and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003499bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003500protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3501modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3502arbitrary criteria.
3503
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003504In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3505a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003506the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003507
3508 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3509 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3510 between responses and new requests.
3511
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003512 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3513 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3514 client-facing connection remains open.
3515
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003516 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3517 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003518
3519The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3520frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3521following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003522weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003523
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003524 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003525
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003526 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3527 ----+-----+-----+----
3528 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3529 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003530 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3531 ----+-----+-----+----
3532 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003533
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003534It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003535only HTTP traffic is handled. But it may be used to handle several protocols
3536within the same frontend. In this case, the client's connection is first handled
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003537as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003538content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data is parsed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003539and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
3540possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003541
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003542There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003543first ones involves a TCP to HTTP/1 upgrade. In HTTP/1, the request
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003544processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003545second one involves a TCP to HTTP/2 upgrade. Because it is a multiplexed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003546protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
3547is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
3548new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003549to understand this difference because that drastically changes the way to
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003550process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
3551already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
3552HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
3553evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
3554one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
3555
3556There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
3557performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
3558tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
3559preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
3560analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
3561HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
3562header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
3563mitigate this drawback.
3564
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003565There are two ways to perform an HTTP upgrade. The first one, the historical
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003566method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
3567set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
3568in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
3569is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
3570to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
3571above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
3572to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
3573"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
3574frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
3575frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
3576as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
3577upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
3578on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
3579the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
3580upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
3581frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
3582remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003583
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020035844.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3585--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003586
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003587The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3588limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3589they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3590limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003591marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003592option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003593and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3594with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
3595specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003596
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003597
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003598 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3599------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3600acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003601backlog X X X -
3602balance X - X X
3603bind - X X -
3604bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003605capture cookie - X X -
3606capture request header - X X -
3607capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003608clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3609clitcpka-idle X X X -
3610clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003611compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003612cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003613declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003614default-server X - X X
3615default_backend X X X -
3616description - X X X
3617disabled X X X X
3618dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003619email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003620email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003621email-alert mailers X X X X
3622email-alert myhostname X X X X
3623email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003624enabled X X X X
3625errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003626errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003627errorloc X X X X
3628errorloc302 X X X X
3629-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3630errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003631force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003632filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003633fullconn X - X X
3634grace X X X X
3635hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01003636http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003637http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003638http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003639http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003640http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003641http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003642http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003643http-check set-var X - X X
3644http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003645http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003646http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003647http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003648http-reuse X - X X
Aurelien DARRAGON17e3cd52023-01-12 15:59:27 +01003649http-send-name-header X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003650id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003651ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003652load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003653log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003654log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003655log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003656log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003657max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003658maxconn X X X -
3659mode X X X X
3660monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003661monitor-uri X X X -
3662option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3663option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3664option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3665option allbackups (*) X - X X
3666option checkcache (*) X - X X
3667option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3668option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003669option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003670option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3671option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003672-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3673option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003674option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3675option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003676option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003677option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003678option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003679option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003680option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Christopher Faulet79507152022-05-16 11:43:10 +02003681option http-restrict-req-hdr-names X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003682option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3683option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3684option httpchk X - X X
3685option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003686option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003687option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003688option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003689option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003690option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003691option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3692option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3693option logasap (*) X X X -
3694option mysql-check X - X X
3695option nolinger (*) X X X X
3696option originalto X X X X
3697option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003698option pgsql-check X - X X
3699option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003700option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003701option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003702option smtpchk X - X X
3703option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3704option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3705option splice-request (*) X X X X
3706option splice-response (*) X X X X
Aurelien DARRAGON54832622023-01-12 15:06:11 +01003707option spop-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003708option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3709option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3710-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003711option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003712option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3713option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3714option tcpka X X X X
3715option tcplog X X X X
3716option transparent (*) X - X X
William Dauchy4711a892022-01-05 22:53:24 +01003717option idle-close-on-response (*) X X X -
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003718external-check command X - X X
3719external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003720persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3721rate-limit sessions X X X -
3722redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003723-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003724retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003725retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003726server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003727server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003728server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003729source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003730srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3731srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3732srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003733stats admin - X X X
3734stats auth X X X X
3735stats enable X X X X
3736stats hide-version X X X X
3737stats http-request - X X X
3738stats realm X X X X
3739stats refresh X X X X
3740stats scope X X X X
3741stats show-desc X X X X
3742stats show-legends X X X X
3743stats show-node X X X X
3744stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003745-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3746stick match - - X X
3747stick on - - X X
3748stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003749stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003750stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003751tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003752tcp-check connect X - X X
3753tcp-check expect X - X X
3754tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003755tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003756tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003757tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003758tcp-check set-var X - X X
3759tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003760tcp-request connection - X X -
3761tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003762tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003763tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003764tcp-response content - - X X
3765tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003766timeout check X - X X
3767timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003768timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003769timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003770timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3771timeout http-request X X X X
3772timeout queue X - X X
3773timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003774timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003775timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003776timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003777transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003778unique-id-format X X X -
3779unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003780use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003781use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003782use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003783------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3784 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003785
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003786
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020037874.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3788---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003789
3790This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3791
3792
3793acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3794 Declare or complete an access list.
3795 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3796 no | yes | yes | yes
3797 Example:
3798 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3799 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3800 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3801
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003802 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003803
3804
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003805backlog <conns>
3806 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3807 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3808 yes | yes | yes | no
3809 Arguments :
3810 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3811 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003812 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003813
3814 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3815 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3816 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3817 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3818 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3819 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3820 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3821 backlog parameter.
3822
3823 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3824 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3825 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3826
3827 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3828
3829
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003830balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003831balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003832 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3833 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3834 yes | no | yes | yes
3835 Arguments :
3836 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3837 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3838 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3839 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3840
3841 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3842 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3843 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3844 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003845 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003846 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003847 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3848 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3849 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3850 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3851 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3852 it, so that you don't worry.
3853
3854 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3855 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3856 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3857 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3858 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3859 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3860 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3861 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003862
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003863 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3864 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3865 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3866 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3867 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3868 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3869 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003870 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3871 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3872 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003873
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003874 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003875 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003876 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3877 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003878 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003879 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3880 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3881 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3882 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3883 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003884 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3885 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3886 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3887 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3888 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3889 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003890
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003891 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3892 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3893 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3894 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3895 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3896 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3897 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3898 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003899 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003900 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003901 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3902 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3903 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003904
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003905 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3906 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3907 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3908 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3909 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3910 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3911 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3912 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3913 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3914 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3915 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3916 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003917
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003918 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003919 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3920 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3921 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3922 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3923 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3924 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3925 URIs start with a leading "/".
3926
3927 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3928 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3929 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3930 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3931
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003932 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3933 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3934 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3935 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3936
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003937 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003938 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3939
3940 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003941 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3942 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003943 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3944 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3945 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3946 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003947 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003948 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3949 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003950
3951 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3952 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3953 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3954 server will receive the request.
3955
3956 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3957 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3958 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3959 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3960 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003961 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3962 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3963 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003964
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003965 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3966 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3967 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3968 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3969 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003970
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003971 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003972 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3973 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3974 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3975
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003976 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3977 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3978 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3979
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003980 random
3981 random(<draws>)
3982 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003983 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3984 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3985 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3986 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003987 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3988 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3989 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3990 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3991 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3992 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3993 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3994 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3995 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3996 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3997 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3998 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3999 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
4000 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
4001 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
4002 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
4003 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
4004 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
4005 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
4006 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004007
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004008 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004009 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004010 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
4011 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +01004012 with the equivalent ACL 'req.rdp_cookie()' function, the name
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004013 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
4014 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
4015 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004016 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004017 used instead.
4018
4019 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
4020 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
4021 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +01004022 a 'req.rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004023
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004024 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4025 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
4026 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
4027
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004028 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02004029 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
4030 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004031
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01004032 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
4033 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
4034 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004035
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004036 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05004037 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004038 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
4039 NTLM relies on.
4040
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004041 Examples :
4042 balance roundrobin
4043 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004044 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004045 balance hdr(User-Agent)
4046 balance hdr(host)
4047 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004048
4049 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
4050 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
4051
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004052 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004053 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
4054 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
4055 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004056 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004057
4058 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
4059 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
4060 defaults to 16 kB.
4061
4062 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
4063 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
4064
4065 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
4066 Round Robin.
4067
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00004068 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004069 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
4070 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
4071 actually appeared in the first chunk).
4072
4073 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
4074
4075 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004076 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004077 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
4078 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
4079 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004080
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004081 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004082
4083
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004084bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
4085bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004086 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
4087 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4088 no | yes | yes | no
4089 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004090 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
4091 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
4092 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
4093 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01004094 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004095 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
4096 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
4097 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
4098 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
4099 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
4100 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004101 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004102 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
4103 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004104 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004105 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4106 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004107 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004108 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4109 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004110 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02004111 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
4112 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
4113 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
4114 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
4115 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
4116 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
4117 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01004118 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
4119 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
4120 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02004121 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
4122 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
4123 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
4124 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004125 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4126 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
4127 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004128
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004129 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
4130 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004131 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
4132 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
4133 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004134 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
4135 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
4136 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
4137 the range.
4138
4139 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
4140 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
4141 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
4142 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
4143 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
4144 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
4145 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004146 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004147 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004148
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004149 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004150 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004151 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
4152 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
4153 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
4154 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
4155 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
4156 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
4157
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004158 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
4159 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
4160 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
4161 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004162
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004163 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
4164 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
4165 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
4166 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
4167 in a frontend.
4168
4169 Example :
4170 listen http_proxy
4171 bind :80,:443
4172 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004173 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004174
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004175 listen http_https_proxy
4176 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02004177 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004178
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004179 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
4180 bind ipv6@:80
4181 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
4182 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
4183
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004184 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004185 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004186
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02004187 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
4188 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
4189 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
4190 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
4191 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
4192
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004193 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004194 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004195
4196
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004197bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004198 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
4199 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4200 yes | yes | yes | yes
4201 Arguments :
4202 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
4203 may be used to override a default value.
4204
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004205 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004206 option may be combined with other numbers.
4207
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004208 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004209 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
4210 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
4211 missing from all processes.
4212
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004213 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004214 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004215 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
4216 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
4217 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
4218 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
4219 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02004220 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004221
4222 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
4223 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
4224 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
4225 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
4226 and 'even' instances.
4227
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004228 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
4229 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
4230 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
4231 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004232
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004233 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
4234 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
4235
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02004236 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
4237 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
4238 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
4239
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004240 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
4241 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
4242
4243 Example :
4244 listen app_ip1
4245 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004246 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004247
4248 listen app_ip2
4249 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004250 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004251
4252 listen management
4253 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004254 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004255
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01004256 listen management
4257 bind 10.0.0.4:80
4258 bind-process 1-4
4259
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004260 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004261
4262
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004263capture cookie <name> len <length>
4264 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
4265 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4266 no | yes | yes | no
4267 Arguments :
4268 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
4269 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
4270 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
4271 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004272 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004273
4274 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
4275 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
4276 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
4277 right if it exceeds <length>.
4278
4279 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
4280 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
4281 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
4282 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
4283
4284 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
4285 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
4286 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
4287
4288 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
4289 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
4290 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01004291 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
4292 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
4293 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004294
4295 Example:
4296 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
4297
4298 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004299 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004300
4301
4302capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004303 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004304 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4305 no | yes | yes | no
4306 Arguments :
4307 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004308 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004309 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4310 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4311 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4312
4313 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4314 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4315 it exceeds <length>.
4316
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004317 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004318 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4319 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004320 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4321 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4322 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4323 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004324 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004325 environments to find where the request came from.
4326
4327 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4328 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4329 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4330 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004331
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004332 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4333 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4334 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4335 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4336 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004337
4338 Example:
4339 capture request header Host len 15
4340 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004341 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004342
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004343 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004344 about logging.
4345
4346
4347capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004348 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004349 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4350 no | yes | yes | no
4351 Arguments :
4352 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004353 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004354 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4355 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4356 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4357
4358 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4359 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4360 it exceeds <length>.
4361
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004362 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004363 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4364 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4365 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004366 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4367 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4368 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4369 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004370
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004371 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4372 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4373 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4374 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4375 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004376
4377 Example:
4378 capture response header Content-length len 9
4379 capture response header Location len 15
4380
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004381 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004382 about logging.
4383
4384
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004385clitcpka-cnt <count>
4386 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4387 the connection on the client side.
4388 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4389 yes | yes | yes | no
4390 Arguments :
4391 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4392
4393 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4394 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004395 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4396 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004397
4398 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4399
4400
4401clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4402 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4403 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4404 client side.
4405 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4406 yes | yes | yes | no
4407 Arguments :
4408 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4409 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4410 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4411 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4412
4413 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4414 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004415 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4416 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004417
4418 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4419
4420
4421clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4422 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4423 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4424 yes | yes | yes | no
4425 Arguments :
4426 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4427 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4428 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4429 document.
4430
4431 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4432 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004433 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4434 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004435
4436 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4437
4438
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004439compression algo <algorithm> ...
4440compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004441compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004442 Enable HTTP compression.
4443 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4444 yes | yes | yes | yes
4445 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004446 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4447 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004448 offload makes HAProxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004449
4450 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004451 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4452 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4453 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004454
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004455 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004456 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004457
4458 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4459 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4460 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4461 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4462 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004463 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004464
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004465 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4466 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4467 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4468 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4469 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4470 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4471 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004472 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004473
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004474 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004475 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004476 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004477 will be no-op: HAProxy will see the compressed response and will not
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004478 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004479 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, HAProxy will compress the
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004480 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004481
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004482 The "offload" setting makes HAProxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004483 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4484 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004485 will be done on the single point where HAProxy is located. However in some
4486 deployment scenarios, HAProxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004487 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004488 In that case HAProxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004489 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4490 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004491 so that prevents HAProxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02004492 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
4493 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004494
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004495 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004496 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4497 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02004498 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004499 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004500 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4501 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4502 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4503 "multipart"
4504 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4505 header
4506 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4507 and later
4508 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4509 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004510 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004511
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004512 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004513
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004514 Examples :
4515 compression algo gzip
4516 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004517
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004518
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004519cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004520 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4521 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004522 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004523 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4524 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4525 yes | no | yes | yes
4526 Arguments :
4527 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4528 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4529 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4530 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4531 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4532 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004533 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004534 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4535 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4536
4537 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004538 server and that HAProxy will have to modify its value to set the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004539 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4540 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4541 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4542 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004543 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4544 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004545 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004546 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4547 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004548
4549 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004550 be inserted by HAProxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004551
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004552 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004553 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004554 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004555 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004556 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4557 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4558 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4559 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4560 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4561 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4562 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004563
4564 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4565 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4566 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4567 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4568 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4569 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4570 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4571 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4572 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004573 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004574 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4575 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4576 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004577
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004578 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4579 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4580 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004581 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4582 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4583 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4584 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004585 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4586 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4587 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004588
4589 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4590 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4591 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4592 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4593 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4594 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4595 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4596 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4597 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4598
4599 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4600 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4601 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4602 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4603 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4604 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4605 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4606 persistence cookie in the cache.
4607 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4608
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004609 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4610 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004611 case, if a cookie is found in the response, HAProxy will leave it
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004612 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4613 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004614 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004615 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4616 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4617 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4618 they logout.
4619
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004620 httponly This option tells HAProxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004621 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4622 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4623 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4624
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004625 secure This option tells HAProxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004626 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4627 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4628 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4629 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4630 this attribute.
4631
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004632 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004633 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004634 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4635 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4636 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4637 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4638 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4639 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004640
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004641 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4642 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4643 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4644 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4645 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4646 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4647 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4648 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004649 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004650 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4651 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4652 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4653 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4654 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4655 the site.
4656
4657 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4658 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4659 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4660 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4661 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4662 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4663 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4664 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4665 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4666 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4667 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4668 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4669 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004670 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004671 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4672 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4673
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004674 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4675 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4676 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4677 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4678 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4679 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4680
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004681 attr This option tells HAProxy to add an extra attribute when a
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004682 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4683 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4684 repeated.
4685
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004686 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4687 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4688 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4689 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004690
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004691 Examples :
4692 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4693 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4694 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004695 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004696
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004697 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004698
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004699
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004700declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4701 Declares a capture slot.
4702 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4703 no | yes | yes | no
4704 Arguments:
4705 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4706
4707 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4708 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4709 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4710 for use in the response.
4711
4712 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004713 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004714 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4715
4716
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004717default-server [param*]
4718 Change default options for a server in a backend
4719 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4720 yes | no | yes | yes
4721 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004722 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4723 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4724 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4725 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004726
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004727 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004728 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4729
4730 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004731
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004732
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004733default_backend <backend>
4734 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4735 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4736 yes | yes | yes | no
4737 Arguments :
4738 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4739
4740 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4741 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4742 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4743 will catch all undetermined requests.
4744
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004745 Example :
4746
4747 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4748 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4749 default_backend dynamic
4750
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004751 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004752
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004753
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004754description <string>
4755 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4756 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4757 no | yes | yes | yes
4758 Arguments : string
4759
4760 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4761 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4762 it describes.
4763 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4764
4765
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004766disabled
4767 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4768 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4769 yes | yes | yes | yes
4770 Arguments : none
4771
4772 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4773 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4774 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4775 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4776 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4777 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4778 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4779
4780 See also : "enabled"
4781
4782
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004783dispatch <address>:<port>
4784 Set a default server address
4785 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4786 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004787 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004788
4789 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4790 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4791 during start-up.
4792
4793 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4794 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4795 possible with normal servers.
4796
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004797 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004798 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4799 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4800 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4801 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4802
4803 See also : "server"
4804
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004805
4806dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4807 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4808 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4809 yes | no | yes | yes
4810 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4811
4812 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004813 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004814 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4815 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004816 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004817 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004818
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004819enabled
4820 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4821 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4822 yes | yes | yes | yes
4823 Arguments : none
4824
4825 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4826 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4827
4828 See also : "disabled"
4829
4830
4831errorfile <code> <file>
4832 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4833 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4834 yes | yes | yes | yes
4835 Arguments :
4836 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004837 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004838 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004839
4840 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004841 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004842 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004843 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4844 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004845
4846 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4847 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4848 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4849
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004850 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4851
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004852 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4853 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4854 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4855 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4856 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4857 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4858 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4859 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4860 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004861
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004862 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4863 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4864 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004865 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004866 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4867
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004868 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004869
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004870 Example :
4871 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004872 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004873 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4874 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4875
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004876
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004877errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4878 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4879 section.
4880 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4881 yes | yes | yes | yes
4882 Arguments :
4883 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4884
4885 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004886 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004887 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
4888 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004889
4890 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4891 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4892 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4893 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4894 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004895 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004896 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4897
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004898 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4899 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004900
4901 Example :
4902 errorfiles generic
4903 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4904
4905
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004906errorloc <code> <url>
4907errorloc302 <code> <url>
4908 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4909 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4910 yes | yes | yes | yes
4911 Arguments :
4912 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004913 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004914 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004915
4916 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4917 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4918 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4919 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004920 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004921
4922 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4923 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4924 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4925
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004926 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4927
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004928 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4929 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4930 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4931 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004932 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004933 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4934 request.
4935
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004936 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004937
4938
4939errorloc303 <code> <url>
4940 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4941 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4942 yes | yes | yes | yes
4943 Arguments :
4944 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004945 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004946 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004947
4948 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4949 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4950 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4951 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004952 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004953
4954 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4955 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4956 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4957
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004958 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4959
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004960 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4961 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4962 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4963 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004964 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004965
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004966 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004967
4968
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004969email-alert from <emailaddr>
4970 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004971 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004972 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4973 yes | yes | yes | yes
4974
4975 Arguments :
4976
4977 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4978
4979 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4980 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4981
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004982 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004983 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4984 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004985
4986
4987email-alert level <level>
4988 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4989 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4990 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4991 yes | yes | yes | yes
4992
4993 Arguments :
4994
4995 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4996 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4997 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4998
4999 By default level is alert
5000
5001 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5002 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5003 for the proxy.
5004
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09005005 Alerts are sent when :
5006
5007 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
5008 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
5009 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
5010 is notice or lower
5011 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
5012 and a health check status update occurs
5013
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005014 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
5015 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005016 section 3.6 about mailers.
5017
5018
5019email-alert mailers <mailersect>
5020 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
5021 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5022 yes | yes | yes | yes
5023
5024 Arguments :
5025
5026 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
5027
5028 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
5029 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5030
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005031 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
5032 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005033
5034
5035email-alert myhostname <hostname>
5036 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
5037 mailers.
5038 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5039 yes | yes | yes | yes
5040
5041 Arguments :
5042
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01005043 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005044
5045 By default the systems hostname is used.
5046
5047 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5048 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5049 for the proxy.
5050
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005051 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
5052 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005053
5054
5055email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005056 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005057 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
5058 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5059 yes | yes | yes | yes
5060
5061 Arguments :
5062
5063 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
5064
5065 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5066 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5067
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005068 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005069 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
5070
5071
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005072force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5073 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
5074 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005075 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005076
5077 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
5078 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
5079 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
5080 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
5081 marked down for maintenance operations.
5082
5083 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5084 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
5085 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
5086 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
5087 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
5088 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
5089 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
5090 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
5091 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
5092
5093 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5094 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
5095 is used.
5096
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005097 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02005098 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005099
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005100
5101filter <name> [param*]
5102 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
5103 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5104 no | yes | yes | yes
5105 Arguments :
5106 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
5107 referenced in section 9.
5108
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005109 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005110 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005111 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
5112 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005113
5114 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
5115 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
5116
5117 Example:
5118 listen
5119 bind *:80
5120
5121 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
5122 filter compression
5123 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
5124
5125 compression algo gzip
5126 compression offload
5127
5128 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5129
5130 See also : section 9.
5131
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005132
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005133fullconn <conns>
5134 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
5135 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5136 yes | no | yes | yes
5137 Arguments :
5138 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
5139 servers use the maximal number of connections.
5140
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005141 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005142 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005143 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005144 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
5145 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
5146 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
5147 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
5148 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005149 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005150
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005151 Since it's hard to get this value right, HAProxy automatically sets it to
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005152 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01005153 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
5154 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
5155 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005156
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005157 Example :
5158 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
5159 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
5160 # connections.
5161 backend dynamic
5162 fullconn 10000
5163 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5164 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5165
5166 See also : "maxconn", "server"
5167
5168
Willy Tarreauab0a5192020-10-09 19:07:01 +02005169grace <time> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005170 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
5171 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01005172 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005173 Arguments :
5174 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
5175 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
5176 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
5177
5178 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
5179 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005180 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005181 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
5182
5183 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
5184 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
5185 simplify it.
5186
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005187
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005188hash-balance-factor <factor>
5189 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
5190 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5191 yes | no | no | yes
5192 Arguments :
5193 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
5194 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01005195 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005196
5197 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
5198 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
5199 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
5200 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
5201 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
5202 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
5203 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
5204
5205 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
5206 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
5207 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
5208 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
5209 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
5210
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02005211 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
5212 consistent hashing mechanism.
5213
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005214 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
5215
5216
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005217hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005218 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
5219 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5220 yes | no | yes | yes
5221 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005222 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
5223 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005224
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005225 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
5226 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
5227 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
5228 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
5229 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
5230 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
5231 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
5232 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
5233 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
5234 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01005235
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005236 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
5237 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
5238 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
5239 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
5240 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
5241 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
5242 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
5243 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
5244 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
5245 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
5246 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
5247 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
5248 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005249 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
5250 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005251
5252 <function> is the hash function to be used :
5253
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005254 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005255 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
5256 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
5257 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005258 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
5259 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
5260 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005261
5262 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
5263 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005264 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
5265 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
5266 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
5267 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
5268
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005269 wt6 this function was designed for HAProxy while testing other
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01005270 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
5271 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
5272 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
5273 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
5274 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
5275 parameter.
5276
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01005277 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
5278 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
5279 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
5280 used on strings.
5281
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005282 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
5283
5284 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
5285 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
5286 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
5287 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
5288 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
5289 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
5290 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
5291 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
5292 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
5293 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
5294 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
5295 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005296
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005297 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5298 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5299 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005300
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005301 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005302
5303
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005304http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5305 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5306 ones).
5307
5308 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5309 no | yes | yes | yes
5310
5311 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5312 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5313 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5314 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5315 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5316 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5317
5318 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5319 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5320 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5321
5322 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5323 below.
5324
5325 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5326 instance.
5327
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005328 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5329 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5330 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5331
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005332 Example:
5333 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5334 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5335 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5336
5337http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5338
5339 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5340 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5341 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5342 example, or to pass some internal information.
5343 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5344 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5345 the resulting header from a previous rule.
5346
5347http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5348
5349 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5350 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
5351
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005352http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005353
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005354 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5355 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5356 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5357 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5358 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005359
5360http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5361 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5362
5363 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5364
5365 Example:
5366 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5367
5368 # applied to:
5369 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5370
5371 # outputs:
5372 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5373
5374 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5375
5376http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5377 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5378
5379 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5380
5381 Example:
5382 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5383
5384 # applied to:
5385 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5386
5387 # outputs:
5388 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5389
5390http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5391
5392 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5393 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5394 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
5395
5396http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5397 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5398
5399 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5400 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5401 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5402 fallback.
5403
5404 Example:
5405 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5406 http-response set-status 431
5407 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5408 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
5409
5410http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5411
5412 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5413 inline.
5414
5415 Arguments:
5416 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5417 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5418 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5419 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5420 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5421 (request and response)
5422 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5423 processing
5424 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5425 processing
5426 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5427 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5428 and '_'.
5429
5430 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5431 followed by some converters.
5432
5433 Example:
5434 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
5435
5436http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
5437
5438 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5439 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5440 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5441 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5442 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005443 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005444 processing.
5445
5446 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
5447 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005448 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005449 rules evaluation.
5450
5451http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5452
5453 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
5454 details about <var-name>.
5455
5456 Example:
5457 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5458
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005459
5460http-check comment <string>
5461 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5462 it fails.
5463 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5464 yes | no | yes | yes
5465
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005466 Arguments :
5467 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5468 rule fails.
5469
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005470 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5471 user-friendly error reporting.
5472
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005473 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005474 "http-check expect".
5475
5476
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005477http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5478 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005479 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005480 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5481 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5482 yes | no | yes | yes
5483
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005484 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005485 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5486
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005487 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005488 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005489
5490 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5491 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5492 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5493 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5494
5495 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5496
5497 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5498
5499 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5500
5501 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5502
5503 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5504
5505 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5506 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5507 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5508 is used.
5509
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005510 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5511 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5512 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5513 haproxy -vv.
5514
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005515 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5516
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005517 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5518 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5519 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5520 different ports or with different servers.
5521
5522 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5523 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5524 the port with a "http-check connect".
5525
5526 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5527 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5528 do.
5529
5530 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5531 unset-var or comment rules.
5532
5533 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005534 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5535 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5536 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5537 option httpchk
5538
5539 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005540 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005541 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005542 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005543 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005544 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005545
5546 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5547
5548 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005549
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005550
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005551http-check disable-on-404
5552 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5553 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005554 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005555 Arguments : none
5556
5557 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5558 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5559 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5560 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5561 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5562 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5563 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5564 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005565 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5566 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005567 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5568 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5569 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005570
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005571 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005572
5573
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005574http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005575 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5576 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5577 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005578 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005579 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005580 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005581
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005582 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005583 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5584
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005585 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5586 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5587 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5588 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5589 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5590 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5591 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5592 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5593 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5594 result is always conclusive.
5595
5596 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5597 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5598 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005599 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5600 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005601 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5602 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005603 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5604 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5605 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005606
5607 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5608 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005609 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5610 supported :
5611 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5612 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005613 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5614 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5615 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5616 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5617 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005618
5619 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5620 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005621 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5622 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5623 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5624 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005625 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5626
5627 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5628 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5629 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5630 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5631
5632 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5633 informational message reported in logs if an error
5634 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5635 log-format string.
5636
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005637 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005638 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5639 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005640 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5641 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5642 details on the supported keywords.
5643
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005644 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5645 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5646 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5647 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005648
5649 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5650 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5651 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5652 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5653 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5654
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005655 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5656 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5657 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5658 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5659 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5660 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5661 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005662
5663 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005664 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005665 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5666 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5667 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5668 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5669
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005670 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5671 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005672 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5673 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5674 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5675 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5676 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5677 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5678 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5679 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005680 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5681 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5682 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5683 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5684 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5685 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5686 insensitive on the header names.
5687
5688 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5689 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5690 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5691 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5692 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5693 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005694
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005695 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005696 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005697 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5698 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5699 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5700 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5701 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005702 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005703 trace).
5704
5705 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005706 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005707 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5708 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5709 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5710 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5711 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005712 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005713
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005714 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5715 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5716 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5717 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5718 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5719 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5720
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005721 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005722 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005723 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5724 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5725 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5726 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5727 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5728 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5729
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005730 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5731 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5732 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5733 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5734 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005735
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005736 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5737 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5738
5739 Examples :
5740 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005741 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005742
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005743 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5744 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5745
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005746 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005747 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005748
5749 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005750 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005751
5752 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005753 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005754
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005755 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005756 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005757
5758
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005759http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005760 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5761 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005762 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5763 health checks.
5764 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5765 yes | no | yes | yes
5766 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005767 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5768
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005769 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5770 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5771 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5772 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5773 to invent non-standard ones.
5774
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005775 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5776 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5777 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5778 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5779
5780 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5781 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5782 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5783 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005784
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005785 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005786 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005787 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005788 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5789 to add it.
5790
5791 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5792 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5793 to the log-format rules.
5794
5795 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5796 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5797 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005798
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005799 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5800 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5801 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5802 request.
5803
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005804 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5805 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5806 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005807 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5808 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5809 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5810 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005811 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005812
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005813 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005814 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
5815 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005816
5817 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5818 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5819 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5820 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5821 configured request authority.
5822
5823 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5824 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005825
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005826 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005827
5828
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005829http-check send-state
5830 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5831 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5832 yes | no | yes | yes
5833 Arguments : none
5834
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005835 When this option is set, HAProxy will systematically send a special header
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005836 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005837 how they are seen by HAProxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5838 manipulated without access to HAProxy and the operator needs to know whether
5839 HAProxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005840
5841 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5842 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5843 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5844 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5845 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005846 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5847 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5848 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5849
5850 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5851 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5852 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5853
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005854 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5855 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5856 checked in multiple backends.
5857
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005858 - a variable "node" containing the name of the HAProxy node, as set in the
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005859 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5860
5861 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5862 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5863 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5864 one fails.
5865
5866 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5867 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5868 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5869
5870 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5871 server's queue.
5872
5873 Example of a header received by the application server :
5874 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5875 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5876
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005877 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5878 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005879
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005880
5881http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005882 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005883 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5884 yes | no | yes | yes
5885
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005886 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005887 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5888 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5889 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5890 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5891 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5892 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5893 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5894 and '-'.
5895
5896 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5897
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005898 Examples :
5899 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005900
5901
5902http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005903 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005904 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5905 yes | no | yes | yes
5906
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005907 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005908 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5909 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5910 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5911 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5912 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5913 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5914 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5915 and '-'.
5916
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005917 Examples :
5918 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005919
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005920
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005921http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5922 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5923 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5924 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5925 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5926 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5927 yes | yes | yes | yes
5928 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005929 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005930 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005931 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005932 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005933
5934 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5935 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5936 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5937 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5938
5939 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5940 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5941 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5942 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5943
5944 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5945 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5946 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5947 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5948 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5949 chroot is performed.
5950
5951 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5952 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5953 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5954 considered.
5955
5956 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5957 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5958 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5959 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5960 considered as a raw string.
5961
5962 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5963 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5964 "content-type".
5965
5966 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5967 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5968 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5969 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5970 evaluated as a log-format string.
5971
5972 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5973 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5974 argument to "content-type".
5975
5976 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5977 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5978 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5979 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5980
5981 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5982 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5983 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5984 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5985 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5986 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5987 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5988 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5989
5990 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5991 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5992 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5993
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005994 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
5995 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
5996 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
5997 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
5998 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
5999
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006000 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
6001 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
6002
6003
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006004http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006005 Access control for Layer 7 requests
6006
6007 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6008 no | yes | yes | yes
6009
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006010 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6011 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6012 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6013 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6014 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006015
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006016 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
6017 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006018
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006019 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006020
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006021 Example:
6022 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
6023 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
6024 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006025
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006026 http-request allow if nagios
6027 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
6028 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
6029 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01006030
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006031 Example:
6032 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
6033 acl add path /addacl
6034 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006035
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006036 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006037
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006038 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
6039 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006040
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006041 Example:
6042 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
6043 acl setmap path /setmap
6044 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006045
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006046 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006047
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006048 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
6049 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006050
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006051 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6052 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006053
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006054http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006055
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006056 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6057 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6058 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6059 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6060 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
6061 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6062 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6063 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006064
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006065http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006066
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006067 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
6068 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
6069 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
6070 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
6071 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
6072 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
6073 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
6074 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006075
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006076http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006077
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006078 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
6079 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006080
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006081
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006082http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006083
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006084 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
6085 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
6086 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
6087 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
6088 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006089
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02006090 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
6091 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
6092 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
6093 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
6094 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
6095 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
6096 instead.
6097
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006098 Example:
6099 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
6100 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006101
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006102http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006103
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006104 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006105
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006106http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6107 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006108
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006109 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
6110 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
6111 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
6112 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
6113 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
6114 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
6115 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
6116 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
6117 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006118
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006119 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
6120 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
6121 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006122 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
6123
6124 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6125 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6126 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6127 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006128
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006129http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006130
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006131 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6132 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6133 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6134 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6135 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6136 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006137
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006138http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006139
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006140 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6141 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6142 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6143 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6144 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006145
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006146http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006147
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006148 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6149 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6150 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6151 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6152 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6153 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006154
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006155http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6156http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6157 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6158 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6159 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6160 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006161
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006162 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
6163 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6164 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006165 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006166 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6167 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6168 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006169 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006170 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006171
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02006172http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6173 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
6174 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
6175 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
6176
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006177http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
6178
6179 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
6180 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
6181 pointed by <resolvers>.
6182 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
6183 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
6184 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
6185 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
6186 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
6187 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
6188 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
6189 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
6190 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
6191 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
William Lallemandac83dba2022-08-26 16:38:43 +02006192 to 0.0.0.0. The do-resolve action takes an host-only parameter, any port must
6193 be removed from the string.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006194
6195 Example:
6196 resolvers mydns
6197 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
6198 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
6199 timeout retry 1s
6200 hold valid 10s
6201 hold nx 3s
6202 hold other 3s
6203 hold obsolete 0s
6204 accepted_payload_size 8192
6205
6206 frontend fe
6207 bind 10.42.0.1:80
William Lallemandac83dba2022-08-26 16:38:43 +02006208 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower,regsub(:[0-9]*$,)
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006209 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
6210
6211 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
6212 # which mean DNS resolution error
6213 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
6214
6215 default_backend be
6216
6217 backend b_503
6218 # dummy backend used to return 503.
6219 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
6220 # 503 error page to end users
6221
6222 backend be
6223 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
6224 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
6225 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
6226 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
6227 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
6228
6229 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
6230 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
6231
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006232http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6233
6234 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
6235 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
6236 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
6237 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01006238 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
6239 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006240
6241 See RFC 8297 for more information.
6242
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006243http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006244http-request normalize-uri fragment-encode [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006245http-request normalize-uri fragment-strip [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006246http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006247http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006248http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006249http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006250http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6251http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006252
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006253 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
6254
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006255 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
Amaury Denoyellea9e639a2021-05-06 15:50:12 +02006256 technical preview. As such, it requires the global directive
6257 'expose-experimental-directives' first to be able to invoke it. You should be
6258 prepared that the behavior of normalizers might change to fix possible
6259 issues, possibly breaking proper request processing in your infrastructure.
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006260
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006261 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
6262 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
6263 the supported backend.
6264
6265 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
6266 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
6267 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
6268 number of segments in the path.
6269
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006270 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
6271 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
6272 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
6273 when improperly combined.
6274
6275 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
6276 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
6277 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
6278 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
6279 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
6280
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006281 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006282
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006283 - fragment-encode: Encodes "#" as "%23".
6284
6285 The "fragment-strip" normalizer should be preferred, unless it is known
6286 that broken clients do not correctly encode '#' within the path component.
6287
6288 Example:
6289 - /#foo -> /%23foo
6290
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006291 - fragment-strip: Removes the URI's "fragment" component.
6292
6293 According to RFC 3986#3.5 the "fragment" component of an URI should not
6294 be sent, but handled by the User Agent after retrieving a resource.
6295
6296 This normalizer should be applied first to ensure that the fragment is
6297 not interpreted as part of the request's path component.
6298
6299 Example:
6300 - /#foo -> /
6301
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006302 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
6303 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006304
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006305 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6306 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
6307
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02006308 Example:
6309 - /. -> /
6310 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
6311 - /a/./a -> /a/a
6312 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006313
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006314 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
6315 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
6316
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006317 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006318 their preceding segment.
6319
6320 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
6321 normalizer first if this is undesired.
6322
6323 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6324 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006325
6326 Example:
6327 - /foo/../ -> /
6328 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
6329 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
6330 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006331 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006332 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006333 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006334
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006335 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
6336 removed as well:
6337
6338 Example:
6339 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
6340 - /bar/../../ -> /
6341
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006342 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
6343 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006344
6345 Example:
6346 - // -> /
6347 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
6348
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006349 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
6350 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
6351
6352 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
6353 ".", "_", and "~".
6354
6355 Example:
6356 - /%61dmin -> /admin
6357 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
6358 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
6359 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
6360
6361 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6362 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6363
6364 Example:
6365 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
6366 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
6367
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006368 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02006369 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02006370
6371 Example:
6372 - /%6f -> /%6F
6373 - /%zz -> /%zz
6374
6375 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6376 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6377
6378 Example:
6379 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
6380
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006381 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02006382 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
6383 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
6384
6385 Example:
6386 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
6387 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
6388 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
6389
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006390http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006391
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006392 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
6393 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
6394 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
6395 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
6396 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006397
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006398http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006399
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006400 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
6401 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
6402 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
6403 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006404
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006405http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6406 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02006407
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006408 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006409 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
6410 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
6411 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
6412 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
6413 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02006414
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006415 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
6416 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
6417 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
6418 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
6419 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006420
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006421 Example:
6422 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
6423
6424 # applied to:
6425 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6426
6427 # outputs:
6428 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6429
6430 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006431
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006432 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
6433
6434 # applied to:
6435 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006436
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006437 # outputs:
6438 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006439
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006440http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6441 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6442
6443 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
6444 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02006445 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
6446 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
6447 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006448
6449 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6450 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6451 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
6452
6453 Example:
6454 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6455 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
6456
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006457 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
6458 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
6459 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
6460 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
6461
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006462http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6463 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6464
6465 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
6466 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
6467 query-string are replaced.
6468
6469 Example:
6470 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
6471 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
6472
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006473http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6474 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6475
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006476 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
6477 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
6478 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
6479 against.
6480
6481 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6482 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6483 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006484
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006485 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
6486 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
6487 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
6488 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
6489 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
6490 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
6491 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
6492 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
6493 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006494 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
6495 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006496
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006497 Example:
6498 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
6499 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006500
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006501 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6502 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006503
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006504http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6505 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006506
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006507 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
6508 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
6509 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
6510 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006511
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006512 Example:
6513 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006514
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006515 # applied to:
6516 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006517
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006518 # outputs:
6519 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006520
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006521http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6522 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6523 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006524 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006525 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6526
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006527 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006528 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6529 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006530 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006531 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006532 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006533 are followed to create the response :
6534
6535 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6536 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6537 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6538 ignored.
6539
6540 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6541 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006542 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006543 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6544 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006545
6546 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6547 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6548 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006549 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006550 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006551
6552 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6553 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6554 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006555 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006556 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006557 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006558
6559 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6560 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6561 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6562 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6563 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6564 as a raw content.
6565
6566 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6567 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6568 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6569 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6570 considered as a raw string.
6571
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006572 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006573 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6574 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6575 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6576
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006577 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6578 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006579 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006580
6581 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6582
6583 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006584 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006585 if { path /ping }
6586
6587 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6588 if { path /favicon.ico }
6589
6590 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6591 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6592 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6593
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006594http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6595http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006596
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006597 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6598 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6599 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006600
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006601http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6602 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006603
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006604 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6605 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6606 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6607 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006608
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006609http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006610
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006611 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6612 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6613 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6614 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6615 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006616
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006617 Arguments:
6618 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6619 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006620
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006621 Example:
6622 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6623 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006624
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006625 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6626 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006627
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006628http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006629
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006630 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6631 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6632 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006633
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006634 Arguments:
6635 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6636 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006637
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006638 Example:
6639 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6640 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006641
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006642 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6643 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6644 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006645
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006646http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006647
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006648 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6649 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6650 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6651 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6652 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006653
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006654 Example:
6655 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6656 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6657 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6658 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6659 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6660 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6661 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6662 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6663 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006664
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006665http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006666
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006667 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6668 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6669 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6670 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6671 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006672
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006673http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6674 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006675
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006676 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6677 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6678 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6679 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6680 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6681 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6682 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6683 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6684 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006685
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006686http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006687
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006688 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6689 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6690 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6691 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
6692 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
6693 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
6694 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006695
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006696http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006697
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006698 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6699 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6700 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006701
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006702http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006703
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006704 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6705 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6706 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6707 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6708 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6709 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6710 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6711 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006712
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006713http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006714
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006715 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6716 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6717 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6718 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6719 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6720 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006721
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006722 Example :
6723 # prepend the host name before the path
6724 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006725
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006726http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6727
6728 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6729 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6730 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6731
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006732http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006733
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006734 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6735 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6736 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6737 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6738 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006739
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006740http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006741
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006742 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6743 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6744 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6745 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6746 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6747 values have higher priority.
6748 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6749 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6750 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6751 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6752 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006753
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006754http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006755
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006756 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6757 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6758 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6759 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6760 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6761 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6762 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006763
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006764 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006765
6766 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006767 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6768 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006769
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006770http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6771 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6772 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6773 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006774 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6775 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006776
6777 Arguments :
6778 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6779 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006780
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006781 See also "option forwardfor".
6782
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006783 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006784 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6785 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6786
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006787 # After the masking this will track connections
6788 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6789 http-request track-sc0 src
6790
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006791 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6792 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6793
6794http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6795
6796 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6797 expression.
6798
6799 Arguments:
6800 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6801 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006802
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006803 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006804 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6805 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6806
6807 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6808 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6809 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6810
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006811http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006812 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6813
6814 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
6815 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
6816 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
6817 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
6818 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
6819
6820 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
6821 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
6822 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
6823 results.
6824
6825 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006826 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
6827 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006828
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006829http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6830
6831 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6832 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6833 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6834 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6835 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6836 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6837 information from the request.
6838
6839 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6840
6841http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6842
6843 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6844 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
Christopher Faulete6794272022-11-22 15:41:48 +01006845 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to perform
6846 complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the path and
6847 the query string. If an absolute URI is set, it will be sent as is to
6848 HTTP/1.1 servers. If it is not the desired behavior, the host, the path
6849 and/or the query string should be set separately.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006850 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6851
6852http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6853
6854 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6855 inline.
6856
6857 Arguments:
6858 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6859 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6860 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6861 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6862 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6863 (request and response)
6864 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6865 processing
6866 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6867 processing
6868 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6869 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6870 and '_'.
6871
6872 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6873 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006874
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006875 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006876 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006877
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006878http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6879 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006880
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006881 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6882 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6883 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6884 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6885 agent name must be used.
6886
6887 Arguments:
6888 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6889
6890 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6891 configuration.
6892
6893http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6894
6895 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6896 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6897 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6898 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6899 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6900 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6901 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6902 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6903 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6904 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6905 action.
6906 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6907 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6908 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6909 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6910 you fully understand how it works.
6911
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006912http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6913
6914 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6915 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6916 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6917 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6918 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006919 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006920 processing.
6921
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006922 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006923 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6924 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6925 rules evaluation.
6926
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006927http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6928http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6929 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6930 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6931 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6932 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006933
6934 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6935 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6936 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006937 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6938 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6939 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6940 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6941 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6942 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006943 things worse by forcing HAProxy and the front firewall to support insane
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006944 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6945 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6946 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006947 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006948 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6949 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6950 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6951 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6952 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006953
6954http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6955http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6956http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6957
6958 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6959 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6960 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6961 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006962 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006963 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6964 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6965 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6966 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6967 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6968 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6969 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6970
6971 Arguments :
6972 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6973 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6974 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6975 select which table entry to update the counters.
6976
6977 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6978 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6979 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6980 that table until the session ends.
6981
6982 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6983 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6984 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6985 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6986 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6987 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6988 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6989 useful information.
6990
6991 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6992 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6993 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6994 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6995 checks that make use of it.
6996
6997http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6998
6999 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007000
7001 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007002 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007003
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01007004http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7005
7006 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
7007 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
7008 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
7009 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
7010 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
7011 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
7012
7013 Arguments :
7014 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
7015
7016 Example:
7017 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
7018
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007019http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7020 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7021
7022 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
7023 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7024 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7025 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7026 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
7027 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
7028 http-buffer-request".
7029
7030 Arguments :
7031
7032 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7033 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7034
7035 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007036 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007037 bytes.
7038
7039 Example:
7040 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
7041
7042 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7043
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007044http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007045
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007046 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
7047 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
7048 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007049
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01007050
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007051http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007052 Access control for Layer 7 responses
7053
7054 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7055 no | yes | yes | yes
7056
7057 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
7058 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
7059 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
7060 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
7061 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
7062 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
7063
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007064 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
7065 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007066
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007067 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007068
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007069 Example:
7070 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02007071
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007072 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007073
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007074 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
7075 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007076
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007077 Example:
7078 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007079
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007080 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007081
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007082 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
7083 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007084
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007085 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7086 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007087
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007088http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007089
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007090 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7091 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7092 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7093 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
7094 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7095 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7096 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7097 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007098
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007099http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007100
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007101 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
7102 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
7103 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
7104 example, or to pass some internal information.
7105 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
7106 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
7107 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007108
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007109http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007110
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007111 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
7112 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007113
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02007114http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007115
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007116 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007117
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007118http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007119
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007120 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
7121 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
7122 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
7123 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
7124 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
7125 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
7126 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007127
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007128 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
7129 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
7130 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
7131 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
7132 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01007133
7134 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
7135 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
7136 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
7137 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007138
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007139http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007140
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007141 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7142 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7143 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7144 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7145 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7146 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02007147
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007148http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02007149
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007150 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
7151 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
7152 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
7153 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
7154 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02007155
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007156http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02007157
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007158 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7159 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7160 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7161 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7162 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
7163 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007164
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007165http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7166http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7167 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7168 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7169 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7170 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007171
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007172 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
7173 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
7174 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007175 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007176 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
7177 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
7178 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01007179 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007180 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007181
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007182http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007183
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007184 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
7185 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
7186 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
7187 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
7188 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
7189 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007190
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007191http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7192 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007193
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007194 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
7195 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007196
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007197 Example:
7198 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02007199
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007200 # applied to:
7201 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007202
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007203 # outputs:
7204 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007205
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007206 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007207
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007208http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7209 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007210
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01007211 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007212 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007213
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007214 Example:
7215 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007216
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007217 # applied to:
7218 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007219
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007220 # outputs:
7221 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007222
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007223http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7224 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7225 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007226 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007227 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7228
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007229 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007230 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
7231 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007232 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007233 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007234 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007235 are followed to create the response :
7236
7237 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
7238 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
7239 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
7240 ignored.
7241
7242 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
7243 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007244 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007245 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
7246 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007247
7248 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
7249 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
7250 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007251 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007252 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007253
7254 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
7255 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
7256 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007257 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007258 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02007259 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007260
7261 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
7262 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
7263 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
7264 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
7265 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
7266 as a raw content.
7267
7268 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
7269 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
7270 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
7271 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
7272 considered as a raw string.
7273
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007274 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
7275 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
7276 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
7277 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
7278
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007279 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
7280 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007281 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007282
7283 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
7284
7285 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007286 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007287 if { status eq 404 }
7288
7289 http-response return content-type text/plain \
7290 string "This is the end !" \
7291 if { status eq 500 }
7292
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007293http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7294http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08007295
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007296 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
7297 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
7298 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007299
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007300http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7301 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007302
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007303 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
7304 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
7305 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
7306 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007307
Christopher Faulet68fc3a12021-08-12 09:32:07 +02007308http-response send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
7309 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007310
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007311 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
7312 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
7313 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
7314 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
7315 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007316
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007317 Arguments:
7318 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007319
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007320 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
7321 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007322
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007323http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007324
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007325 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
7326 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
7327 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007328
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007329http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7330
7331 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
7332 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
7333 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
7334 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
7335 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
7336
7337http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7338
7339 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7340 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7341 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
7342 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
7343 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
7344 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7345 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7346 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
7347 be triggered by an HTTP response.
7348
7349http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7350
7351 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
7352 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7353 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
7354 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
7355 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
7356 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
7357 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
7358
7359http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7360
7361 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
7362 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
7363 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
7364 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
7365 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
7366 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7367 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7368 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
7369
7370http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7371 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7372
7373 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
7374 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
7375 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
7376 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007377
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007378 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007379 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
7380 http-response set-status 431
7381 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
7382 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007383
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007384http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007385
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007386 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
7387 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
7388 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
7389 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
7390 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
7391 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
7392 based on some information from the request.
7393
7394 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
7395
7396http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7397
7398 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
7399 inline.
7400
7401 Arguments:
7402 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
7403 scope. The scopes allowed are:
7404 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
7405 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
7406 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
7407 (request and response)
7408 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
7409 processing
7410 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
7411 processing
7412 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
7413 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
7414 and '_'.
7415
7416 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7417 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007418
7419 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007420 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007421
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007422http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007423
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007424 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
7425 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
7426 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
7427 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
7428 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
7429 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
7430 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
7431 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
7432 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
7433 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
7434 action.
7435 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
7436 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
7437 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
7438 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
7439 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007440
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007441http-response strict-mode { on | off }
7442
7443 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
7444 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
7445 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
7446 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
7447 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007448 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007449 processing.
7450
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01007451 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007452 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007453 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007454 rules evaluation.
7455
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007456http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7457http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7458http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007459
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007460 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
7461 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
7462 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
7463 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
7464 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007465 supported, HAProxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007466
7467http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7468
7469 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
7470 about <var-name>.
7471
7472 Example:
7473 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
7474
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007475http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7476 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7477
7478 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
7479 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7480 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7481 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7482 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the response
7483 buffer is full.
7484
7485 Arguments :
7486
7487 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7488 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7489
7490 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007491 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007492 bytes.
7493
7494 Example:
7495 http-response wait-for-body time 1s at-least 10k
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02007496
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007497http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
7498 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
7499
7500 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7501 yes | no | yes | yes
7502
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007503 By default, a connection established between HAProxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007504 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
7505 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
7506 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007507
7508 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
7509
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007510 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
7511 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
7512 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
7513 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
7514 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
7515 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
7516 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007517 such an application could be an old HAProxy using cookie
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007518 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
7519 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007520
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007521 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
7522 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
7523 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
7524 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
7525 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
7526 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
7527 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02007528 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
7529 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
7530 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
7531 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
7532 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
7533 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007534
7535 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
7536 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
7537 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
7538 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
7539 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
7540 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
7541 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
7542 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02007543 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007544 downsides of rare connection failures.
7545
7546 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
7547 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
7548 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
7549 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
7550 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
7551 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007552 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007553 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
7554 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
7555 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
7556 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
7557 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
7558
7559 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007560 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
7561 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
7562 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
7563 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007564
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007565 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
7566 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007567
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01007568 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007569
7570 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
7571 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
7572 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
7573
Willy Tarreauee9afa22022-11-25 09:17:18 +01007574 The rules to decide to keep an idle connection opened or to close it after
7575 processing are also governed by the "tune.pool-low-fd-ratio" (default: 20%)
7576 and "tune.pool-high-fd-ratio" (default: 25%). These correspond to the
7577 percentage of total file descriptors spent in idle connections above which
7578 haproxy will respectively refrain from keeping a connection opened after a
7579 response, and actively kill idle connections. Some setups using a very high
7580 ratio of idle connections, either because of too low a global "maxconn", or
7581 due to a lot of HTTP/2 or HTTP/3 traffic on the frontend (few connections)
7582 but HTTP/1 connections on the backend, may observe a lower reuse rate because
7583 too few connections are kept open. It may be desirable in this case to adjust
7584 such thresholds or simply to increase the global "maxconn" value.
7585
7586 Similarly, when thread groups are explicitly enabled, it is important to
7587 understand that idle connections are only usable between threads from a same
7588 group. As such it may happen that unfair load between groups leads to more
7589 idle connections being needed, causing a lower reuse rate. The same solution
7590 may then be applied (increase global "maxconn" or increase pool ratios).
7591
7592 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn", "thread-groups",
7593 "tune.pool-high-fd-ratio", "tune.pool-low-fd-ratio"
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007594
7595
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007596http-send-name-header [<header>]
7597 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007598 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7599 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007600 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007601 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
7602
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02007603 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
7604 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
7605 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
7606 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
7607 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
7608 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
7609 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
7610 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
7611 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
7612 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
7613 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
7614 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
7615 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
7616 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
7617 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
7618 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007619
7620 See also : "server"
7621
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007622id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007623 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
7624 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7625 no | yes | yes | yes
7626 Arguments : none
7627
7628 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
7629 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
7630 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007631
7632
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007633ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
7634 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
7635 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01007636 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007637
7638 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
7639 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
7640 and running).
7641
7642 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
7643 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
7644 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007645 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007646 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
7647
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007648 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
7649 "unless" condition is met.
7650
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007651 Example:
7652 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7653 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7654 ignore-persist if url_static
7655
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007656 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
7657
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007658load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7659 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7660 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7661 yes | no | yes | yes
7662
7663 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7664 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7665 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007666 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007667 to tell HAProxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007668 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7669 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7670 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7671
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007672 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007673 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007674 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007675
7676 Arguments:
7677 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7678 named "server-state-file".
7679
7680 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7681 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7682 name is used as a file name.
7683
7684 none don't load any stat for this backend
7685
7686 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007687 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7688 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7689 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007690 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007691 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007692
7693 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7694 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7695
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007696 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007697
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007698 global
7699 stats socket /tmp/socket
7700 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007701
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007702 defaults
7703 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007704
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007705 backend bk
7706 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7707 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007708
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007709
7710 Then one can run :
7711
7712 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7713
7714 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7715
7716 1
7717 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7718 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7719 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7720
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007721 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007722
7723 global
7724 stats socket /tmp/socket
7725 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7726
7727 defaults
7728 load-server-state-from-file local
7729
7730 backend bk
7731 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7732 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7733
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007734
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007735 Then one can run :
7736
7737 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7738
7739 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7740
7741 1
7742 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7743 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7744 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7745
7746 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7747 "show servers state"
7748
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007749
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007750log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007751log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007752 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007753no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007754 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7755 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7756 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007757
7758 Prefix :
7759 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7760 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7761 prefix does not allow arguments.
7762
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007763 Arguments :
7764 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7765 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7766 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7767 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7768 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7769 parameter.
7770
7771 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7772 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7773
7774 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7775 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7776 standard syslog port).
7777
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007778 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7779 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7780 standard syslog port).
7781
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007782 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7783 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7784 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007785 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007786
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007787 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7788 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7789 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7790 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7791 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7792 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7793 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7794 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7795 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7796 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7797 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7798 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007799 significantly slow HAProxy down as non-blocking calls will be
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007800 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7801 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7802 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007803 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7804 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007805
7806 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7807 and "fd@2", see above.
7808
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007809 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7810 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7811 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7812 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7813 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7814 having the logs instantly available.
7815
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007816 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
7817 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
7818 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
7819
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007820 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7821 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007822
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007823 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7824 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7825 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7826 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7827 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7828 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7829 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7830 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7831 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7832 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007833 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007834
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007835 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7836 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7837 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7838 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7839 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7840
7841 <sample_size>
7842 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7843 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7844 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7845 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7846 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7847
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007848 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7849 one of the following :
7850
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007851 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7852 field is stripped. This is the default.
7853 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7854 rfc3164.
7855
7856 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007857 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7858
7859 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7860 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7861
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007862 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7863 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7864 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7865 designed to be used with a local log server.
7866
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007867 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7868 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7869 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7870 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7871 systemd logger consumes.
7872
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007873 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7874 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7875 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7876 used with a local log server.
7877
7878 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7879 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7880 designed to be used with a local log server.
7881
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007882 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7883 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7884 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7885 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7886
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007887 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7888
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007889 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7890 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7891 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7892
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007893 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7894 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7895 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7896 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007897
7898 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7899 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7900 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007901 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7902 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7903 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7904 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7905 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007906
7907 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7908
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007909 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7910 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7911 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007912
7913 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7914 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7915 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7916 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7917
7918 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7919 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007920
7921 Example :
7922 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007923 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7924 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7925 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007926 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007927 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
7928 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007929 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007930
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007931
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007932log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007933 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7934 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7935 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007936
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007937 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7938 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7939 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7940 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7941 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007942
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007943 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
7944 "option httplog" directives.
7945
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007946log-format-sd <string>
7947 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7948 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7949 yes | yes | yes | no
7950
7951 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7952 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7953 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7954 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7955 which covers the log format string in depth.
7956
7957 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7958 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7959
7960 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7961 log format to "rfc5424".
7962
7963 Example :
7964 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7965
7966
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007967log-tag <string>
7968 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7969 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7970 yes | yes | yes | yes
7971
7972 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7973 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007974 from the command line, which usually is "HAProxy". Sometimes it can be useful
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007975 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7976 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7977 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7978 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7979 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7980 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007981
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007982max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7983 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7984 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7985 yes | no | yes | yes
7986
7987 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7988 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7989 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7990 servers.
7991
7992 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007993 connections at which HAProxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007994 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7995 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7996 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007997 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007998 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7999 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
8000 picking a different server.
8001
8002 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
8003 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
8004 even if they have to be queued.
8005
8006 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
8007 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
8008
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01008009max-session-srv-conns <nb>
8010 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
8011 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
8012 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008013
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008014maxconn <conns>
8015 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
8016 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8017 yes | yes | yes | no
8018 Arguments :
8019 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
8020 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
8021 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
8022 closes.
8023
8024 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008025 very high so that HAProxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008026 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
8027 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01008028 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
8029 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
8030 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
8031 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008032
8033 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
8034 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
8035 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
8036
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01008037 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
8038 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02008039
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008040 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
8041
8042
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02008043mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008044 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
8045 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8046 yes | yes | yes | yes
8047 Arguments :
8048 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
8049 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
8050 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
8051 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
8052
8053 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
8054 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
8055 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
8056 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
8057 brings HAProxy most of its value.
8058
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008059 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
8060 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
8061 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008062
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008063 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008064 defaults http_instances
8065 mode http
8066
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008067
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008068monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008069 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008070 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8071 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008072 Arguments :
8073 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
8074 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008075 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008076 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
8077 backend and its backup.
8078
8079 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
8080 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
8081 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
8082 servers in a list of backends.
8083
8084 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
8085 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
8086 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008087 conditions above is met, HAProxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008088 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
8089 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008090 HAProxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02008091 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
8092 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008093
8094 Example:
8095 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008096 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008097 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8098 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8099 monitor-uri /site_alive
8100 monitor fail if site_dead
8101
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008102 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008103
8104
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008105monitor-uri <uri>
8106 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
8107 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8108 yes | yes | yes | no
8109 Arguments :
8110 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
8111 health status instead of forwarding the request.
8112
8113 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
8114 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
8115 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
8116 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
8117 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
8118 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
8119 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
8120 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
8121
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01008122 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008123 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
8124 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
Willy Tarreau28848542022-11-25 10:24:44 +01008125 purpose. Only one URI may be configured for monitoring; when multiple
8126 "monitor-uri" statements are present, the last one will define the URI to
8127 be used. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008128 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
8129 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
8130 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008131
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01008132 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
8133 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
8134 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
8135 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
8136
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008137 Example :
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008138 # Use /haproxy_test to report HAProxy's status
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008139 frontend www
8140 mode http
8141 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
8142
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008143 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008144
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008145
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008146option abortonclose
8147no option abortonclose
8148 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
8149 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8150 yes | no | yes | yes
8151 Arguments : none
8152
8153 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
8154 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
8155 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
8156 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008157 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008158 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
8159 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
8160 encountered while delivering the response.
8161
8162 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
8163 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
8164 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
8165 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
8166 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
8167 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008168 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008169 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008170 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008171 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
8172 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
8173 still not served and not pollute the servers.
8174
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008175 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
8176 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008177 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
8178 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
8179 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
8180 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
8181 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
8182 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008183 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008184
8185 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8186 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8187
8188 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
8189
8190
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008191option accept-invalid-http-request
8192no option accept-invalid-http-request
8193 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
8194 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8195 yes | yes | yes | no
8196 Arguments : none
8197
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008198 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008199 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008200 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008201 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8202 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8203 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8204 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8205 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008206 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
8207 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
8208 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
8209 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008210 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008211 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02008212 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
8213 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
8214 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008215
8216 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8217 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8218 been confirmed.
8219
8220 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8221 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008222 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
8223 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008224 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8225
8226 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8227 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8228
8229 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
8230 stats socket.
8231
8232
8233option accept-invalid-http-response
8234no option accept-invalid-http-response
8235 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
8236 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8237 yes | no | yes | yes
8238 Arguments : none
8239
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008240 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008241 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008242 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008243 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8244 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8245 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8246 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8247 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008248 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
8249 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
8250 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008251
8252 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8253 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8254 been confirmed.
8255
8256 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8257 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
8258 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
8259 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8260
8261 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8262 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8263
8264 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
8265 stats socket.
8266
8267
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008268option allbackups
8269no option allbackups
8270 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
8271 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8272 yes | no | yes | yes
8273 Arguments : none
8274
8275 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
8276 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
8277 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
8278 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
8279 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
8280 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
8281 order between the backup servers anymore.
8282
8283 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
8284 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
8285
8286 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8287 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8288
8289
8290option checkcache
8291no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08008292 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008293 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8294 yes | no | yes | yes
8295 Arguments : none
8296
8297 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
8298 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008299 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008300 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
8301 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008302 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008303
8304 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008305 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008306 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008307 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
8308 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008309 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008310 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01008311 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
8312 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008313 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01008314 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
8315 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008316 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008317 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
8318 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
8319 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
8320 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
8321 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
8322 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
8323 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
8324 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
8325 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
8326
8327 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008328 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
8329 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
8330 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
8331 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008332
8333 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
8334 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008335 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008336 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008337
8338 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8339 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8340
8341
8342option clitcpka
8343no option clitcpka
8344 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
8345 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8346 yes | yes | yes | no
8347 Arguments : none
8348
8349 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8350 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008351 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008352 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8353
8354 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8355 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8356 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8357 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8358
8359 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8360 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8361 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8362 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8363 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8364
8365 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8366
8367 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8368 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8369 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
8370
8371 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8372 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8373
8374 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
8375
8376
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008377option contstats
8378 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
8379 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8380 yes | yes | yes | no
8381 Arguments : none
8382
8383 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
8384 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
8385 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008386 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from HAProxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01008387 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
8388 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
8389 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
8390 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
8391 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008392
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008393option disable-h2-upgrade
8394no option disable-h2-upgrade
8395 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
8396 connection.
8397 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8398 yes | yes | yes | no
8399 Arguments : none
8400
8401 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
8402 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
8403 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
8404 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01008405 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
8406 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
8407 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
8408 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
8409 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
8410 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008411
8412 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8413 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008414
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008415option dontlog-normal
8416no option dontlog-normal
8417 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
8418 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8419 yes | yes | yes | no
8420 Arguments : none
8421
8422 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
8423 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
8424 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
8425 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
8426 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
8427 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
8428 logged.
8429
8430 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
8431 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
8432 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
8433
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008434 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008435 logging.
8436
8437
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008438option dontlognull
8439no option dontlognull
8440 Enable or disable logging of null connections
8441 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8442 yes | yes | yes | no
8443 Arguments : none
8444
8445 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
8446 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
8447 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
8448 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
8449 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
8450 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008451 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
8452 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
8453 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008454
8455 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008456 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008457 would not be logged.
8458
8459 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8460 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8461
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008462 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008463 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008464
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008465
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008466option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008467 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
8468 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8469 yes | yes | yes | yes
8470 Arguments :
8471 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8472 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008473 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008474 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008475
8476 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
8477 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
8478 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
8479 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
8480 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
8481 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
8482 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008483 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
8484 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8485 possible that the client has already brought one.
8486
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008487 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008488 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008489 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008490 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008491 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008492 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008493
8494 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8495 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8496 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8497 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8498 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8499 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01008500 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008501
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008502 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
8503 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008504 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching HAProxy
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008505 are under the control of the end-user.
8506
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008507 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008508 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8509 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008510 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
8511 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
8512 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008513
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008514 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008515 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
8516 frontend www
8517 mode http
8518 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
8519
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008520 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
8521 backend www
8522 mode http
8523 option forwardfor header X-Client
8524
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008525 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008526 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008527
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008528
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02008529option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8530no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8531 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
8532 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8533 yes | yes | yes | no
8534 Arguments : none
8535
8536 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8537 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8538 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8539 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8540 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8541 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8542 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8543
8544 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
8545 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
8546 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
8547 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8548 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
8549 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8550 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8551 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
8552 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8553 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8554
8555 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
8556
8557 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8558 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8559
8560 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
8561 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8562
8563
8564option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8565no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8566 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
8567 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8568 yes | no | yes | yes
8569 Arguments : none
8570
8571 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8572 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8573 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8574 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8575 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8576 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8577 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8578
8579 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
8580 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
8581 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
8582 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8583 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
8584 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8585 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8586 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
8587 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8588 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8589
8590 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
8591
8592 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8593 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8594
8595 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
8596 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8597
8598
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008599option http-buffer-request
8600no option http-buffer-request
8601 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
8602 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8603 yes | yes | yes | yes
8604 Arguments : none
8605
8606 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
8607 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
8608 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
8609 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
8610 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
8611 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01008612 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
8613 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
8614 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
8615 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008616
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008617 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
8618 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008619
8620
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008621option http-ignore-probes
8622no option http-ignore-probes
8623 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
8624 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8625 yes | yes | yes | no
8626 Arguments : none
8627
8628 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
8629 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
8630 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
8631 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
8632 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
8633 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
8634 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
8635 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
8636 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008637 was received over a connection before it was closed;
8638 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008639 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
8640
8641 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
8642 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
8643 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
8644 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
8645 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
8646 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
8647 are often the only way to detect them.
8648
8649 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8650 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8651
8652 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
8653
8654
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008655option http-keep-alive
8656no option http-keep-alive
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008657 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server for HTTP/1.x
8658 connections
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008659 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8660 yes | yes | yes | yes
8661 Arguments : none
8662
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008663 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008664 HTTP/1.x connections: for each connection it processes each request and
8665 response, and leaves the connection idle on both sides. This mode may be
8666 changed by several options such as "option http-server-close" or "option
8667 httpclose". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be
8668 useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008669
8670 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8671 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008672 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8673 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8674 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8675 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8676 situations where this option may be useful :
8677
8678 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008679 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008680
8681 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8682 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8683
8684 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008685
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008686 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8687 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8688 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8689 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8690 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8691 not set.
8692
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008693 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008694 http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008695
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008696 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008697 "option prefer-last-server" and "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008698
8699
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008700option http-no-delay
8701no option http-no-delay
8702 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8703 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8704 yes | yes | yes | yes
8705 Arguments : none
8706
8707 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8708 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8709 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8710 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8711 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8712 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8713 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008714 HAProxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008715 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8716 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8717 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8718 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8719 affected.
8720
8721 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8722 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8723 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8724 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8725 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8726 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8727 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8728 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8729 latency environments.
8730
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008731 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8732
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008733
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008734option http-pretend-keepalive
8735no option http-pretend-keepalive
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008736 Define whether HAProxy will announce keepalive for HTTP/1.x connection to the
8737 server or not
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008738 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008739 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008740 Arguments : none
8741
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008742 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", HAProxy
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008743 adds a "Connection: close" header to the HTTP/1.x request forwarded to the
8744 server. Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically
8745 refrain from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length,
8746 while this is totally unrelated. The effect is that a client or a cache could
8747 receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and consider the
8748 response complete.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008749
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008750 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", HAProxy will make the server
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008751 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008752 to the abnormal undesired above. When HAProxy gets the whole response, it
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008753 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008754 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008755 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8756
8757 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8758 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8759 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8760 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008761 worth noting that when this option is enabled, HAProxy will have slightly
8762 less work to do. So if HAProxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008763 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8764
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008765 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8766 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8767 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008768 frontend.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008769
8770 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8771 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8772
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008773 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008774 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008775
Christopher Faulet79507152022-05-16 11:43:10 +02008776option http-restrict-req-hdr-names { preserve | delete | reject }
8777 Set HAProxy policy about HTTP request header names containing characters
8778 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset
8779 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8780 yes | yes | yes | yes
8781 Arguments :
8782 preserve disable the filtering. It is the default mode for HTTP proxies
8783 with no FastCGI application configured.
8784
8785 delete remove request headers with a name containing a character
8786 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset. It is the default mode for
8787 HTTP backends with a configured FastCGI application.
8788
8789 reject reject the request with a 403-Forbidden response if it contains a
8790 header name with a character outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset.
8791
8792 This option may be used to restrict the request header names to alphanumeric
8793 and hyphen characters ([A-Za-z0-9-]). This may be mandatory to interoperate
8794 with non-HTTP compliant servers that fail to handle some characters in header
8795 names. It may also be mandatory for FastCGI applications because all
8796 non-alphanumeric characters in header names are replaced by an underscore
8797 ('_'). Thus, it is easily possible to mix up header names and bypass some
8798 rules. For instance, "X-Forwarded-For" and "X_Forwarded-For" headers are both
8799 converted to "HTTP_X_FORWARDED_FOR" in FastCGI.
8800
8801 Note this option is evaluated per proxy and after the http-request rules
8802 evaluation.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008803
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008804option http-server-close
8805no option http-server-close
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008806 Enable or disable HTTP/1.x connection closing on the server side
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008807 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8808 yes | yes | yes | yes
8809 Arguments : none
8810
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008811 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008812 HTTP/1.x connections: for each connection it processes each request and
8813 response, and leaves the connection idle on both sides. This mode may be
8814 changed by several options such as "option http-server-close" or "option
8815 httpclose". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close
8816 mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive
8817 and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the
8818 client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side
8819 to save server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
8820 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
8821 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
8822 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
8823 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
8824 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008825
8826 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8827 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8828 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8829 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008830 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8831 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008832
8833 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8834 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008835 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8836 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8837 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008838
8839 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8840 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8841
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008842 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive" and
8843 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008844
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008845option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008846no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008847 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8848 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8849 yes | yes | yes | no
8850 Arguments : none
8851
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008852 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008853 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8854 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8855 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8856 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8857 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008858 HAProxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008859
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008860 By setting this option in a frontend, HAProxy can automatically switch to use
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008861 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008862 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8863 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8864 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008865
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008866 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8867 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8868 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8869 front of an existing proxy.
8870
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008871 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8872
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008873 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008874
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008875option httpchk
8876option httpchk <uri>
8877option httpchk <method> <uri>
8878option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008879 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008880 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8881 yes | no | yes | yes
8882 Arguments :
8883 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8884 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8885 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8886 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8887 ones.
8888
8889 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8890 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8891 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8892
8893 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8894 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8895 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008896 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008897
8898 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8899 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8900 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8901 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8902 the lack of any response.
8903
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008904 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8905 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8906 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8907 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8908
8909 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8910 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8911 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008912
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008913 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8914 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008915 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008916 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008917 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008918
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008919 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8920 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8921 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8922 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8923
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008924 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008925 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8926 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8927 backend https_relay
8928 mode tcp
8929 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8930 http-check send hdr Host www
8931 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008932
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008933 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8934 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8935 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008936
8937
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008938option httpclose
8939no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008940 Enable or disable HTTP/1.x connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008941 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8942 yes | yes | yes | yes
8943 Arguments : none
8944
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008945 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008946 HTTP/1.x connections: for each connection it processes each request and
8947 response, and leaves the connection idle on both sides. This mode may be
8948 changed by several options such as "option http-server-close" or "option
8949 httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008950
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008951 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close the client or the server
8952 connection, depending where the option is set. Only the frontend is
8953 considered for client connections while the frontend and the backend are
8954 considered for server ones. In this case the option is enabled if at least
8955 one of the frontend or backend holding the connection has it enabled. If the
8956 option is set on a listener, it is applied both on client and server
8957 connections. It will check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in
8958 each direction, and will add one if missing.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008959
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008960 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008961 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" request header, but will
8962 still cause the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008963
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008964 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008965 http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008966
8967 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8968 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8969
Christopher Faulet84145a72023-02-20 17:09:34 +01008970 See also : "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008971
8972
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008973option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008974 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8975 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008976 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008977 Arguments :
8978 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8979 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8980 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008981 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008982 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008983
8984 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8985 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8986 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8987 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8988 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8989 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8990 ports.
8991
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008992 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8993 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008994
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008995 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8996
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008997 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008998
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008999
9000option http_proxy
9001no option http_proxy
9002 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
9003 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9004 yes | yes | yes | yes
9005 Arguments : none
9006
9007 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
9008 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
9009 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
9010 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
9011 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
9012
9013 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
9014 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01009015 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
9016 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009017
9018 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9019 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9020
9021 Example :
9022 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
9023 backend direct_forward
9024 option httpclose
9025 option http_proxy
9026
9027 See also : "option httpclose"
9028
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009029
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009030option independent-streams
9031no option independent-streams
9032 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009033 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9034 yes | yes | yes | yes
9035 Arguments : none
9036
9037 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
9038 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
9039 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
9040 receive data or not.
9041
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009042 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009043 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
9044 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
9045 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
9046 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
9047 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
9048 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
9049 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
9050 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
9051 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
9052 socket buffers.
9053
9054 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
9055 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
9056 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
9057 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
9058 slow lines, so use it with caution.
9059
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009060 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009061
9062
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02009063option ldap-check
9064 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
9065 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9066 yes | no | yes | yes
9067 Arguments : none
9068
9069 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
9070 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
9071 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
9072 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
9073
9074 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
9075 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
9076
9077 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
9078 configure it.
9079
9080 Example :
9081 option ldap-check
9082
9083 See also : "option httpchk"
9084
9085
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009086option external-check
9087 Use external processes for server health checks
9088 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9089 yes | no | yes | yes
9090
9091 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
9092 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
9093 command".
9094
9095 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
9096
9097 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
9098
9099
William Dauchy4711a892022-01-05 22:53:24 +01009100option idle-close-on-response
9101no option idle-close-on-response
9102 Avoid closing idle frontend connections if a soft stop is in progress
9103 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9104 yes | yes | yes | no
9105 Arguments : none
9106
9107 By default, idle connections will be closed during a soft stop. In some
9108 environments, a client talking to the proxy may have prepared some idle
9109 connections in order to send requests later. If there is no proper retry on
9110 write errors, this can result in errors while haproxy is reloading. Even
9111 though a proper implementation should retry on connection/write errors, this
9112 option was introduced to support backwards compatibility with haproxy prior
9113 to version 2.4. Indeed before v2.4, haproxy used to wait for a last request
9114 and response to add a "connection: close" header before closing, thus
9115 notifying the client that the connection would not be reusable.
9116
9117 In a real life example, this behavior was seen in AWS using the ALB in front
9118 of a haproxy. The end result was ALB sending 502 during haproxy reloads.
9119
9120 Users are warned that using this option may increase the number of old
9121 processes if connections remain idle for too long. Adjusting the client
9122 timeouts and/or the "hard-stop-after" parameter accordingly might be
9123 needed in case of frequent reloads.
9124
9125 See also: "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout http-request",
9126 "hard-stop-after"
9127
9128
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009129option log-health-checks
9130no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009131 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009132 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9133 yes | no | yes | yes
9134 Arguments : none
9135
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009136 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
9137 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
9138 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009139
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009140 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
9141 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
9142 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
9143 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
9144 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
9145
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009146 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009147 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009148
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009149 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
9150 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
9151 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009152
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009153
9154option log-separate-errors
9155no option log-separate-errors
9156 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
9157 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9158 yes | yes | yes | no
9159 Arguments : none
9160
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009161 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes HAProxy
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009162 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
9163 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
9164 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
9165 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
9166 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
9167 provides very important information.
9168
9169 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
9170 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
9171 error logs.
9172
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009173 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009174 logging.
9175
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009176
9177option logasap
9178no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009179 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009180 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9181 yes | yes | yes | no
9182 Arguments : none
9183
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009184 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
9185 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
9186 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
9187 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
9188
9189 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
9190 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
9191 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
9192 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
9193 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009194 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009195 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
9196 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
9197 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
9198 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009199 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009200
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009201 Examples :
9202 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
9203 mode http
9204 option httplog
9205 option logasap
9206 log 192.168.2.200 local3
9207
9208 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9209 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9210 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
9211 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9212
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009213 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009214 logging.
9215
9216
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009217option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009218 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009219 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9220 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009221 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009222 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
9223 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009224 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
9225 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009226
9227 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
9228 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009229 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009230 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
Daniel Black9dc310d2021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009231 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires an unlocked authorised
9232 user without a password. To create a basic limited user in MySQL with
9233 optional resource limits:
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009234
Daniel Black9dc310d2021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009235 CREATE USER '<username>'@'<ip_of_haproxy|network_of_haproxy/netmask>'
9236 /*!50701 WITH MAX_QUERIES_PER_HOUR 1 MAX_UPDATES_PER_HOUR 0 */
9237 /*M!100201 MAX_STATEMENT_TIME 0.0001 */;
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009238
9239 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009240 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009241 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
9242 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
9243 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
9244 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
9245 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
9246 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
9247 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
9248
9249 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
9250 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009251
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02009252 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009253
9254 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
9255 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
9256 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9257 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009258 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009259 server to route the client via the machine hosting HAProxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009260
9261 See also: "option httpchk"
9262
9263
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009264option nolinger
9265no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009266 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009267 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9268 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009269 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009270
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009271 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009272 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
9273 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
9274 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
9275 connections.
9276
9277 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
9278 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009279 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
9280 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
9281 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
9282 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
9283 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
9284 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
9285 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
9286 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
9287 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
9288 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
9289 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
9290 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
9291 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009292
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009293 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
9294 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
9295 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
9296 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
9297 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009298
9299 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
9300 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009301 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +05009302 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009303 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009304
9305 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9306 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9307
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009308 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
9309 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009310
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009311option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
9312 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
9313 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9314 yes | yes | yes | yes
9315 Arguments :
9316 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9317 matching <network>
9318 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
9319 header name.
9320
9321 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
9322 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
9323 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
9324 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
9325 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
9326 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
9327 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
9328 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
9329 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9330 possible that the client has already brought one.
9331
9332 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
9333 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
9334 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
9335 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
9336 header and requires different one.
9337
9338 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9339 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9340 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +01009341 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
9342 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
9343 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
9344 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
9345 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009346
9347 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
9348 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9349 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
9350 both are defined.
9351
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009352 Examples :
9353 # Original Destination address
9354 frontend www
9355 mode http
9356 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
9357
9358 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
9359 backend www
9360 mode http
9361 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
9362
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009363 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009364
9365
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009366option persist
9367no option persist
9368 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
9369 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9370 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009371 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009372
9373 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
9374 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
9375 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
9376 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
9377 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
9378 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
9379 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
9380 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
9381 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
9382 redirected to another valid server.
9383
9384 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9385 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9386
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01009387 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009388
9389
Christopher Faulet36136e52022-10-03 15:00:59 +02009390option pgsql-check user <username>
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01009391 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
9392 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9393 yes | no | yes | yes
9394 Arguments :
9395 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
9396 PostgreSQL server.
9397
9398 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
9399 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
9400 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
9401 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
9402
9403 See also: "option httpchk"
9404
9405
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009406option prefer-last-server
9407no option prefer-last-server
9408 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
9409 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9410 yes | no | yes | yes
9411 Arguments : none
9412
9413 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009414 request was sent to a server to which HAProxy still holds a connection, it is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009415 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
9416 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009417 we only indicate a preference which HAProxy tries to apply without any form
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009418 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009419 this option is used, HAProxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009420 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
9421 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009422 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009423 HAProxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02009424 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
9425 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
9426 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009427 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
9428 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
9429 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009430
9431 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9432 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9433
9434 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
9435
9436
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009437option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009438option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009439no option redispatch
9440 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
9441 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9442 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009443 Arguments :
9444 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
9445 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
9446 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009447 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009448 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009449 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009450 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
9451 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
9452 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
9453
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009454
9455 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
9456 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
9457 be able to access the service anymore.
9458
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01009459 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
9460 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009461
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02009462 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
9463 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
9464 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
9465 following order:
9466
9467 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
9468
9469 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
9470 list, or
9471
9472 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
9473
9474 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
9475 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
9476
9477 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
9478 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
9479 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
9480 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
9481
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009482 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009483 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
9484 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009485
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009486 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9487 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9488
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009489 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009490
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009491
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009492option redis-check
9493 Use redis health checks for server testing
9494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9495 yes | no | yes | yes
9496 Arguments : none
9497
9498 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
9499 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9500 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
9501 find the "+PONG" response message.
9502
9503 Example :
9504 option redis-check
9505
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009506 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009507
9508
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009509option smtpchk
9510option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
9511 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
9512 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9513 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009514 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009515 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02009516 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009517 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
9518
9519 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
9520 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
9521 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
9522
9523 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
9524 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
9525 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
9526 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
9527 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
9528 dead server.
9529
9530 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
9531 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009532 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009533 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
9534
9535 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
9536 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
9537 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9538 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009539 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009540
9541 Example :
9542 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
9543
9544 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
9545
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009546
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009547option socket-stats
9548no option socket-stats
9549
9550 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
9551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9552 yes | yes | yes | no
9553
9554 Arguments : none
9555
9556
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009557option splice-auto
9558no option splice-auto
9559 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
9560 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9561 yes | yes | yes | yes
9562 Arguments : none
9563
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009564 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009565 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009566 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009567 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009568 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009569 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
9570 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
9571 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
9572 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9573
9574 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
9575 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
9576 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
9577 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
9578 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
9579 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
9580 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
9581 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
9582 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
9583 keyword.
9584
9585 Example :
9586 option splice-auto
9587
9588 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9589 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9590
9591 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
9592 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9593
9594
9595option splice-request
9596no option splice-request
9597 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
9598 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9599 yes | yes | yes | yes
9600 Arguments : none
9601
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009602 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009603 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009604 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9605 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9606 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9607 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9608
9609 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9610
9611 Example :
9612 option splice-request
9613
9614 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9615 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9616
9617 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
9618 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9619
9620
9621option splice-response
9622no option splice-response
9623 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
9624 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9625 yes | yes | yes | yes
9626 Arguments : none
9627
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009628 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009629 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009630 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9631 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9632 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9633 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9634
9635 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9636
9637 Example :
9638 option splice-response
9639
9640 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9641 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9642
9643 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
9644 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9645
9646
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009647option spop-check
9648 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
9649 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Aurelien DARRAGON54832622023-01-12 15:06:11 +01009650 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009651 Arguments : none
9652
9653 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
9654 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9655 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
9656 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
9657
9658 Example :
9659 option spop-check
9660
9661 See also : "option httpchk"
9662
9663
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009664option srvtcpka
9665no option srvtcpka
9666 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
9667 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9668 yes | no | yes | yes
9669 Arguments : none
9670
9671 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9672 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009673 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009674 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9675
9676 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9677 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9678 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9679 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9680
9681 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9682 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9683 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9684 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9685 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9686
9687 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9688
9689 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9690 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9691 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
9692
9693 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9694 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9695
9696 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
9697
9698
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009699option ssl-hello-chk
9700 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
9701 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9702 yes | no | yes | yes
9703 Arguments : none
9704
9705 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
9706 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
9707 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
9708 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
9709 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
9710 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
9711 hello message.
9712
9713 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9714 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9715 messages, which is appreciable.
9716
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009717 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into HAProxy
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009718 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9719 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009720
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009721 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9722
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009723
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009724option tcp-check
9725 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9726 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9727 yes | no | yes | yes
9728
9729 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9730 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9731
9732 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9733 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9734 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9735
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009736 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009737 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9738 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9739 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9740 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9741 only.
9742
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009743 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009744 The connection is opened and HAProxy waits for the server to present some
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009745 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9746 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9747 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9748
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009749 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009750 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9751 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009752 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009753 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9754 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9755 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9756 the respective protocols.
9757 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009758 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009759
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009760 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009761
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009762 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9763 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9764 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9765 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009766
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009767 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9768 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9769 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009770
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009771
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009772 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009773 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009774 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009775 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009776
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009777 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009778 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009779 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009780
9781 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9782 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009783 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009784 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009785 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009786 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009787 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009788 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009789 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9790 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009791 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009792 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9793 tcp-check expect string +OK
9794
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009795 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009796 (send many headers before analyzing)
9797 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009798 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009799 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9800 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9801 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9802 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009803 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009804
9805
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009806 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009807
9808
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009809option tcp-smart-accept
9810no option tcp-smart-accept
9811 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9812 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9813 yes | yes | yes | no
9814 Arguments : none
9815
9816 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9817 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9818 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9819 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9820 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9821 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9822
9823 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9824 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9825 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9826 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9827
9828 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9829 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9830 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009831 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009832
9833 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9834 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9835 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9836
9837 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9838 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9839 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9840
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009841 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9842
9843
9844option tcp-smart-connect
9845no option tcp-smart-connect
9846 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9847 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9848 yes | no | yes | yes
9849 Arguments : none
9850
9851 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9852 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9853 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9854 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9855 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9856
9857 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9858 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9859 complex.
9860
9861 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9862 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9863 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9864
9865 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9866 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9867
9868 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9869
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009870
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009871option tcpka
9872 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9873 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9874 yes | yes | yes | yes
9875 Arguments : none
9876
9877 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9878 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009879 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009880 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9881
9882 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9883 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9884 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9885 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9886
9887 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9888 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9889 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9890 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9891 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9892
9893 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9894
9895 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9896 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9897 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9898 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9899 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9900 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9901 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9902 backends.
9903
9904 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9905
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009906
9907option tcplog
9908 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9909 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009910 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009911 Arguments : none
9912
9913 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9914 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9915 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9916 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9917 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9918 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9919 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9920 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9921
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009922 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9923
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009924 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009925
9926
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009927option transparent
9928no option transparent
9929 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9930 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009931 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009932 Arguments : none
9933
9934 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9935 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9936 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9937 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9938 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9939 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9940 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9941 appropriate server.
9942
9943 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9944 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9945
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009946 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009947 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009948
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009949
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009950external-check command <command>
9951 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9952 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9953 yes | no | yes | yes
9954
9955 Arguments :
9956 <command> is the external command to run
9957
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009958 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9959
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009960 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009961
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009962 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9963 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9964 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9965 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9966 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9967 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009968
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009969 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9970
9971 Environment variables :
9972 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9973 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9974
9975 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9976
9977 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9978
9979 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9980 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9981 for a UNIX socket).
9982
9983 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9984
9985 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9986
9987 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9988
9989 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9990
9991 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9992
9993 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9994 socket).
9995
9996 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9997 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9998
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009999 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
10000
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010001 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
10002 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
10003 failed.
10004
10005 Example :
10006 external-check command /bin/true
10007
10008 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
10009
10010
10011external-check path <path>
10012 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
10013 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10014 yes | no | yes | yes
10015
10016 Arguments :
10017 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
10018
10019 The default path is "".
10020
10021 Example :
10022 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
10023
10024 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
10025 "external-check command"
10026
10027
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010028persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +020010029persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010030 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
10031 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10032 yes | no | yes | yes
10033 Arguments :
10034 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020010035 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
10036 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010037
10038 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
10039 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010040 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010041 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
10042 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
10043 forwarded to this server.
10044
10045 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
10046 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
10047 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010048 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010049 a single "listen" section.
10050
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020010051 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
10052 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
10053 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
10054
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010055 Example :
10056 listen tse-farm
10057 bind :3389
10058 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
10059 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10060 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
10061 # apply RDP cookie persistence
10062 persist rdp-cookie
10063 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010064 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010065 balance rdp-cookie
10066 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
10067 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
10068
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010010069 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010070
10071
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010072rate-limit sessions <rate>
10073 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
10074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10075 yes | yes | yes | no
10076 Arguments :
10077 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
10078 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
10079
10080 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
10081 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
10082 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010083 (in system buffers) and HAProxy will not even be aware that sessions are
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010084 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
10085 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
10086
10087 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
10088 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
10089 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
10090 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
10091
10092 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
10093 listen smtp
10094 mode tcp
10095 bind :25
10096 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +020010097 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010098
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +020010099 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
10100 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
10101 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010102
10103 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
10104
10105
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010106redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10107redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10108redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010109 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
10110 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10111 no | yes | yes | yes
10112
10113 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +010010114 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010115
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010116 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010117 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010118 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
10119 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
10120 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010121
10122 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
10123 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
10124 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
10125 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
10126 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010127 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
10128 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
10129 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
10130 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010131
10132 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
10133 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
10134 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
10135 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
10136 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
10137 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010138 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010139 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010140 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
10141 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
10142 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010143
10144 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010145 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
10146 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
10147 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +020010148 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010149 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
10150 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
10151 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
10152 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010153
10154 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010155 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010156
10157 - "drop-query"
10158 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
10159 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
10160 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
10161 with a location-type redirect.
10162
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010163 - "append-slash"
10164 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
10165 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
10166 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
10167 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
10168
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010169 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
10170 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
10171 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
10172 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
10173 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
10174 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
10175 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
10176
10177 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
10178 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
10179 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
10180 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
10181 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
10182 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
10183 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010184
10185 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
10186 acl clear dst_port 80
10187 acl secure dst_port 8080
10188 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010189 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010190 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010191 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
10192
10193 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010194 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
10195 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
10196 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010197 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010198
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010199 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
10200 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
10201 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
10202
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010203 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by HAProxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +010010204 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010205
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010206 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +020010207 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10208 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
10209 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010210
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010211 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010212
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +010010213
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010214retries <value>
Willy Tarreaucc834882022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010215 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a failure
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010216 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10217 yes | no | yes | yes
10218 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaucc834882022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010219 <value> is the number of times a request or connection attempt should be
10220 retried on a server after a failure.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010221
Willy Tarreaucc834882022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010222 By default, retries apply only to new connection attempts. However, when
10223 the "retry-on" directive is used, other conditions might trigger a retry
10224 (e.g. empty response, undesired status code), and each of them will count
10225 one attempt, and when the total number attempts reaches the value here, an
10226 error will be returned.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010227
10228 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010229 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
Willy Tarreaucc834882022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010230 a retry occurs on the same server.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010231
Willy Tarreaucc834882022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010232 When "option redispatch" is set, some retries may be performed on another
10233 server even if a cookie references a different server. By default this will
10234 only be the last retry unless an argument is passed to "option redispatch".
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010235
10236 See also : "option redispatch"
10237
10238
Lukas Tribusbb474ff2021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010239retry-on [space-delimited list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +020010240 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
10241 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
10242 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010243 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10244 yes | no | yes | yes
10245 Arguments :
Lukas Tribusbb474ff2021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010246 <keywords> is a space-delimited list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each
10247 representing a type of failure event on which an attempt to
10248 retry the request is desired. Please read the notes at the
10249 bottom before changing this setting. The following keywords are
10250 supported :
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010251
10252 none never retry
10253
10254 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
10255 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
10256
10257 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
10258 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
10259 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
10260 request timeout on the server side, poor network
10261 condition, or a server crash or restart while
10262 processing the request.
10263
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020010264 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
10265 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
10266 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
10267 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
10268 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
10269 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
10270 overflow attack for example).
10271
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010272 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
10273 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
10274 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
10275 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
10276 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
10277 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
10278 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
10279 amplify denial of service attacks.
10280
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020010281 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
10282 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
10283 considered to be safe to retry.
10284
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010010285 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
10286 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
10287 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
10288 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
10289 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010290
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020010291 all-retryable-errors
10292 retry request for any error that are considered
10293 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
10294 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
10295 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
10296
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010297 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
10298 not cumulative.
10299
10300 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
10301 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
10302 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
10303 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
10304
10305 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
10306 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
10307 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
10308 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
10309 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
10310 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
10311 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
10312 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
10313 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
10314 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
10315 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
10316 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
10317
10318 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
10319 should not use this directive.
10320
10321 The default is "conn-failure".
10322
Lukas Tribusbb474ff2021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010323 Example:
10324 retry-on 503 504
10325
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010326 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
10327
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010328server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010329 Declare a server in a backend
10330 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10331 no | no | yes | yes
10332 Arguments :
10333 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010334 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010335 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010336
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010337 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
10338 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
10339 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
10340 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010341 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
10342 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010343 intercepted and HAProxy must forward to the original destination
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010344 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
10345 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010346 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
10347 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
10348 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
10349 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
10350 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10351 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10352 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010353 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020010354 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
10355 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
10356 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
10357 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
10358 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
10359 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010360 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10361 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010362 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
10363 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010364
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010365 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010366 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
10367 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
10368 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
10369 adding this value to the client's port.
10370
10371 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
10372 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010373 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010374
10375 Examples :
10376 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
10377 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010378 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010379 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
10380 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
10381 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010382
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020010383 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
10384 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
10385 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
10386 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
10387 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
10388
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010389 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
10390 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010391
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010392server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010393 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010394 this backend.
10395 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10396 no | no | yes | yes
10397
10398 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
10399 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
10400 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
10401 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
10402 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010403
10404 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
10405 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
10406
10407 global
10408 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
10409
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010010410 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010411 load-server-state-from-file
10412
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010413 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010414 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010415
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020010416server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
10417 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
10418 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
10419 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10420 no | no | yes | yes
10421
10422 Arguments:
10423 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
10424
10425 <num | range>
10426 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
10427 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
10428 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
10429 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
10430
10431 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
10432
10433 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
10434
10435 <params*>
10436 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
10437 keyword.
10438
10439 Examples:
10440 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
10441 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
10442 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
10443
10444 # or
10445 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
10446
10447 # would be equivalent to:
10448 server srv1 google.com:80 check
10449 server srv2 google.com:80 check
10450 server srv3 google.com:80 check
10451
10452
10453
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010454source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010455source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010456source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010457 Set the source address for outgoing connections
10458 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10459 yes | no | yes | yes
10460 Arguments :
10461 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
10462 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010463
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010464 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010465 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
10466 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
10467 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
10468 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
10469 supported prefixes are :
10470 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10471 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10472 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010473 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020010474 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10475 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010476
10477 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
10478 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010479 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
10480 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
10481 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010482
10483 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
10484 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
10485 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
10486 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
10487 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
10488 <addr>.
10489
10490 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
10491 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
10492 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
10493 port.
10494
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010495 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
10496 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
10497 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
10498 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010010499 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010500 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
10501 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
10502 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
10503 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
10504 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
10505 HTTP header.
10506
10507 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
10508 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010509 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010510 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
10511 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10512 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
10513 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
10514 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
10515 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
10516 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
10517
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010518 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
10519 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
10520 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
10521 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
10522 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
10523 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
10524
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010525 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
10526 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
10527 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
10528 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
10529
10530 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
10531 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
10532 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
10533 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
10534 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
10535 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
10536
10537 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
10538 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
10539 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
10540 there are two methods :
10541
10542 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
10543 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
10544 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
10545 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
10546 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
10547 of the client ranges may be used.
10548
10549 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
10550 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
10551 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
10552 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
10553 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
10554 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
10555 same session.
10556
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010557 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
10558 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
10559 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010560 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010561
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020010562 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
10563
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010564 Examples :
10565 backend private
10566 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
10567 source 192.168.1.200
10568
10569 backend transparent_ssl1
10570 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
10571 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10572
10573 backend transparent_ssl2
10574 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
10575 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
10576 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
10577
10578 backend transparent_ssl3
10579 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
10580 # is more conntrack-friendly.
10581 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10582
10583 backend transparent_smtp
10584 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
10585 # with Tproxy version 4.
10586 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
10587
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010588 backend transparent_http
10589 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
10590 # proxy.
10591 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
10592
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010593 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010594 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
10595
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010596
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010597srvtcpka-cnt <count>
10598 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
10599 the connection on the server side.
10600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10601 yes | no | yes | yes
10602 Arguments :
10603 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
10604
10605 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
10606 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010607 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10608 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010609
10610 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10611
10612
10613srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
10614 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
10615 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
10616 server side.
10617 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10618 yes | no | yes | yes
10619 Arguments :
10620 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
10621 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
10622 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
10623 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
10624
10625 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
10626 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010627 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10628 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010629
10630 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10631
10632
10633srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
10634 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
10635 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10636 yes | no | yes | yes
10637 Arguments :
10638 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
10639 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
10640 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
10641 document.
10642
10643 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
10644 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010645 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10646 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010647
10648 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
10649
10650
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010651stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
10652 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
10653 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010654 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010655
10656 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
10657 matched.
10658
10659 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
10660 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
10661
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010662 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10663 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010664 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010665
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010010666 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
10667 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
10668 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
10669 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010670
10671 Example :
10672 # statistics admin level only for localhost
10673 backend stats_localhost
10674 stats enable
10675 stats admin if LOCALHOST
10676
10677 Example :
10678 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
10679 backend stats_auth
10680 stats enable
10681 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
10682 stats admin if TRUE
10683
10684 Example :
10685 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
10686 userlist stats-auth
10687 group admin users admin
10688 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
10689 group readonly users haproxy
10690 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
10691
10692 backend stats_auth
10693 stats enable
10694 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
10695 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
10696 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
10697 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
10698
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010699 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
10700 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
10701 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010702
10703
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010704stats auth <user>:<passwd>
10705 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
10706 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010707 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010708 Arguments :
10709 <user> is a user name to grant access to
10710
10711 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
10712
10713 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
10714 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
10715 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
10716 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
10717 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
10718 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
10719
10720 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
10721 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10722 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010723 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010724
10725 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10726 report using "stats scope".
10727
10728 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10729 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10730 unobvious parameters.
10731
10732 Example :
10733 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10734 backend public_www
10735 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10736 stats enable
10737 stats hide-version
10738 stats scope .
10739 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010740 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010741 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10742 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10743
10744 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10745 backend private_monitoring
10746 stats enable
10747 stats uri /admin?stats
10748 stats refresh 5s
10749
10750 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10751
10752
10753stats enable
10754 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10755 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010756 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010757 Arguments : none
10758
10759 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10760 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10761 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10762 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10763 - stats auth : no authentication
10764 - stats scope : no restriction
10765
10766 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10767 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10768 unobvious parameters.
10769
10770 Example :
10771 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10772 backend public_www
10773 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10774 stats enable
10775 stats hide-version
10776 stats scope .
10777 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010778 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010779 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10780 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10781
10782 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10783 backend private_monitoring
10784 stats enable
10785 stats uri /admin?stats
10786 stats refresh 5s
10787
10788 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10789
10790
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010791stats hide-version
10792 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010793 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010794 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010795 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010796
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010797 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10798 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10799 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10800 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10801 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10802 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010803
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010804 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10805 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10806 unobvious parameters.
10807
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010808 Example :
10809 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10810 backend public_www
10811 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010812 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010813 stats hide-version
10814 stats scope .
10815 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010816 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010817 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10818 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010819
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010820 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10821 backend private_monitoring
10822 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010823 stats uri /admin?stats
10824 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010825
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010826 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010827
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010828
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010829stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10830 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10831 Access control for statistics
10832
10833 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10834 no | no | yes | yes
10835
10836 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10837 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10838 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10839 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10840 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10841 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10842
10843 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10844 instance.
10845
10846 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10847 about ACL usage.
10848
10849
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010850stats realm <realm>
10851 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10852 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010853 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010854 Arguments :
10855 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10856 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10857 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10858
10859 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10860 using a backslash ('\').
10861
10862 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10863 only related to authentication.
10864
10865 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10866 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10867 unobvious parameters.
10868
10869 Example :
10870 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10871 backend public_www
10872 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10873 stats enable
10874 stats hide-version
10875 stats scope .
10876 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010877 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010878 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10879 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10880
10881 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10882 backend private_monitoring
10883 stats enable
10884 stats uri /admin?stats
10885 stats refresh 5s
10886
10887 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10888
10889
10890stats refresh <delay>
10891 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10892 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010893 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010894 Arguments :
10895 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10896 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10897 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10898 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10899 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10900 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10901
10902 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10903 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10904 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010905 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010906
10907 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10908 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10909 unobvious parameters.
10910
10911 Example :
10912 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10913 backend public_www
10914 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10915 stats enable
10916 stats hide-version
10917 stats scope .
10918 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010919 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010920 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10921 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10922
10923 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10924 backend private_monitoring
10925 stats enable
10926 stats uri /admin?stats
10927 stats refresh 5s
10928
10929 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10930
10931
10932stats scope { <name> | "." }
10933 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10934 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010935 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010936 Arguments :
10937 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10938 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10939 section in which the statement appears.
10940
10941 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10942 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10943 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10944 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10945 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10946 exists.
10947
10948 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10949 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10950 unobvious parameters.
10951
10952 Example :
10953 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10954 backend public_www
10955 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10956 stats enable
10957 stats hide-version
10958 stats scope .
10959 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010960 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010961 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10962 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10963
10964 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10965 backend private_monitoring
10966 stats enable
10967 stats uri /admin?stats
10968 stats refresh 5s
10969
10970 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10971
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010972
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010973stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010974 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10975 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010976 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010977
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010978 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010979 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10980
10981 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10982 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10983
10984 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10985 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010986 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010987
10988 Example :
10989 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10990 backend private_monitoring
10991 stats enable
10992 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10993 stats uri /admin?stats
10994 stats refresh 5s
10995
10996 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10997 global section.
10998
10999
11000stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011001 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
11002 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11003 yes | yes | yes | yes
11004 Arguments : none
11005
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011006 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011007 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
11008 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
11009 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
11010 - IP (socket, server)
11011 - cookie (backend, server)
11012
11013 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11014 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011015 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011016
11017 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
11018
11019
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020011020stats show-modules
11021 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
11022 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11023 yes | yes | yes | yes
11024 Arguments : none
11025
11026 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
11027 values as a tooltip.
11028
11029 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11030 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11031 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
11032
11033 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
11034
11035
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011036stats show-node [ <name> ]
11037 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
11038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011039 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011040 Arguments:
11041 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
11042 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
11043
11044 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
11045 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011046 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011047
11048 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11049 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11050 unobvious parameters.
11051
11052 Example:
11053 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11054 backend private_monitoring
11055 stats enable
11056 stats show-node Europe-1
11057 stats uri /admin?stats
11058 stats refresh 5s
11059
11060 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
11061 section.
11062
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011063
11064stats uri <prefix>
11065 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
11066 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011067 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011068 Arguments :
11069 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
11070 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
11071 query string.
11072
11073 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
11074 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
11075 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
11076 possible to reach it in the application.
11077
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011078 The default URI compiled in HAProxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011079 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011080 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
11081 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
11082 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
11083 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
11084
11085 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
11086 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
11087 an address or a port to statistics only.
11088
11089 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11090 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11091 unobvious parameters.
11092
11093 Example :
11094 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11095 backend public_www
11096 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11097 stats enable
11098 stats hide-version
11099 stats scope .
11100 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011101 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011102 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11103 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11104
11105 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11106 backend private_monitoring
11107 stats enable
11108 stats uri /admin?stats
11109 stats refresh 5s
11110
11111 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
11112
11113
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011114stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
11115 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011116 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011117 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011118
11119 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011120 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011121 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011122 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011123 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
11124
11125 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11126 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11127 the "stick-table" statement.
11128
11129 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
11130 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
11131 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
11132 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
11133 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
11134
11135 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11136 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
11137 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
11138 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
11139 transformation rules.
11140
11141 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11142 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11143 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11144 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11145 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11146 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11147 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11148
11149 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
11150 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
11151 ACL based conditions.
11152
11153 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
11154 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
11155 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
11156 matches can be used as fallbacks.
11157
11158 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
11159 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
11160 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
11161 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
11162
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011163 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11164 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011165 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011166
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011167 Example :
11168 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11169 # last 30 minutes
11170 backend pop
11171 mode tcp
11172 balance roundrobin
11173 stick store-request src
11174 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11175 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11176 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11177
11178 backend smtp
11179 mode tcp
11180 balance roundrobin
11181 stick match src table pop
11182 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11183 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11184
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011185 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011186 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011187
11188
11189stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11190 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
11191 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11192 no | no | yes | yes
11193
11194 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
11195 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
11196 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
11197 for writing more maintainable configurations.
11198
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011199 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11200 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011201 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011202
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011203 Examples :
11204 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010011205 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011206
11207 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
11208 stick match src table pop if !localhost
11209 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
11210
11211
11212 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
11213 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
11214 backend http
11215 mode http
11216 balance roundrobin
11217 stick on src table https
11218 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
11219 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
11220 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
11221
11222 backend https
11223 mode tcp
11224 balance roundrobin
11225 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11226 stick on src
11227 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11228 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11229
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011230 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011231
11232
11233stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11234 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
11235 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11236 no | no | yes | yes
11237
11238 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011239 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011240 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011241 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011242 server is selected.
11243
11244 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11245 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11246 the "stick-table" statement.
11247
11248 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11249 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11250 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
11251 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
11252 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
11253 address.
11254
11255 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11256 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
11257 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
11258 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
11259 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
11260 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
11261 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
11262 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
11263 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
11264 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
11265
11266 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11267 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11268 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11269 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11270 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11271 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11272 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11273
11274 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
11275 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11276 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
11277 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11278
11279 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
11280 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11281 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11282 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11283 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11284 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011285 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
11286 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11287 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11288 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11289 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11290 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011291
11292 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
11293 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
11294 the request.
11295
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011296 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11297 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011298 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011299
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011300 Example :
11301 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11302 # last 30 minutes
11303 backend pop
11304 mode tcp
11305 balance roundrobin
11306 stick store-request src
11307 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11308 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11309 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11310
11311 backend smtp
11312 mode tcp
11313 balance roundrobin
11314 stick match src table pop
11315 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11316 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11317
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011318 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011319 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011320
11321
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011322stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011323 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011324 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080011325 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011326 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011327 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011328
11329 Arguments :
11330 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
11331 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
11332 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11333 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11334
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010011335 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
11336 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
11337 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11338 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11339
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011340 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
11341 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
11342 instance.
11343
11344 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
11345 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
11346 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
11347 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
11348 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
11349 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011350 to 32 characters.
11351
11352 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
11353 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
11354 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011355 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011356 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
11357 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011358
11359 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011360 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
11361 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011362 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
11363 increase.
11364
11365 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011366 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
11367 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
11368 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011369
11370 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011371 is full. When not specified and the table is full when HAProxy
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011372 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
11373 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011374 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011375 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
11376 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
11377 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
11378 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
11379 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
11380 parameter (see below).
11381
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011382 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
11383 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
11384 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
11385 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
11386 soft restart.
11387
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020011388 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
11389 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011390
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011391 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
Emeric Brunad57d202022-05-30 18:08:28 +020011392 was last created, refreshed using 'track-sc' or matched using
11393 'stick match' or 'stick on' rule. The expiration delay is
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011394 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
11395 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011396 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011397 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011398 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
11399 if not expiration delay is specified.
Emeric Brunad57d202022-05-30 18:08:28 +020011400 Note: 'table_*' converters performs lookups but won't update touch
11401 expire since they don't require 'track-sc'.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011402
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011403 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
11404 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
11405 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
11406 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
11407 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
11408 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
11409 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
11410 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
11411 token.
11412
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011413 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
11414 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
11415 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
11416 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011417 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
11418 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
11419 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
11420 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
11421 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
11422 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
11423 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
11424 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
11425 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
11426 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
11427 types and their arguments.
11428
11429 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
11430 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
11431 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
11432 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
11433
11434 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11435 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11436 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011437 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011438
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011439 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11440 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11441 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011442 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011443 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011444 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011445
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011446 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11447 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11448 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11449 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
11450
11451 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
11452 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11453 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
11454 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
11455 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
11456 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
11457
Emeric Bruna5d15312021-07-01 18:34:48 +020011458 - gpt0 : first General Purpose Tag. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11459 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11460 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11461 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches
11462
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011463 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11464 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
11465 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
11466 they were received.
11467
11468 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11469 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
11470 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
11471 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
11472 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
11473
11474 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11475 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11476 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11477 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
11478 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11479
11480 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11481 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
11482 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
11483
11484 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11485 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11486 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11487 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
11488 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11489
11490 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11491 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
11492 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
11493 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
11494 the client side.
11495
11496 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11497 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11498 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11499 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
11500 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
11501 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
11502 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
11503
11504 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11505 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
11506 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11507 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
11508 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
11509 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011510 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011511
11512 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11513 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11514 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11515 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11516 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
11517 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11518
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010011519 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11520 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
11521 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11522 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
11523 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
11524
11525 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11526 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11527 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11528 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11529 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
11530 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11531
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011532 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011533 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011534 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
11535 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
11536
11537 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11538 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11539 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11540 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11541 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11542 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
11543 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
11544 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
11545 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
11546 recommended for better fairness.
11547
11548 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011549 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011550 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
11551 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
11552
11553 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11554 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11555 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11556 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11557 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11558 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
11559 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
11560 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
11561 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
11562 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011563
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011564 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
11565 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011566 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
11567 reference it.
11568
11569 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
11570 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010011571 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
11572 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
11573 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011574
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011575 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
11576 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
11577 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
11578 something that can be ignored.
11579
11580 Example:
11581 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
11582 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
11583 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
11584 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
11585
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011586 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010011587 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011588
11589
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011590stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010011591 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011592 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11593 no | no | yes | yes
11594
11595 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011596 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011597 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011598 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011599 server is selected.
11600
11601 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11602 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11603 the "stick-table" statement.
11604
11605 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11606 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11607 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
11608 when the response is a SSL server hello.
11609
11610 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11611 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
11612 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
11613 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
11614 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
11615 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011616 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011617 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
11618 rules.
11619
11620 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11621 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11622 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11623 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11624 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11625 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11626 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11627
11628 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
11629 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11630 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
11631 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11632
11633 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
11634 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11635 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11636 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11637 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11638 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011639 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
11640 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11641 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11642 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11643 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11644 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
11645 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
11646 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
11647 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011648
11649 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
11650
11651 Example :
11652 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
11653 backend https
11654 mode tcp
11655 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011656 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011657 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011658
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011659 acl clienthello req.ssl_hello_type 1
11660 acl serverhello rep.ssl_hello_type 2
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011661
11662 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
11663 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11664 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
11665
11666 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
11667 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011668
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011669 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
11670 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
11671 # at offset 44.
11672
11673 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011674 stick on req.payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011675
11676 # Learn on response if server hello.
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011677 stick store-response resp.payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011678
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011679 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11680 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11681
11682 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
11683 extraction.
11684
11685
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011686tcp-check comment <string>
11687 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
11688 it fails.
11689 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11690 yes | no | yes | yes
11691
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011692 Arguments :
11693 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
11694 rule fails.
11695
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011696 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
11697 user-friendly error reporting.
11698
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011699 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
11700 "tcp-check expect".
11701
11702
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011703tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
11704 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011705 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011706 Opens a new connection
11707 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011708 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011709
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011710 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011711 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11712
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011713 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040011714 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011715
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011716 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011717 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
11718 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011719 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011720
11721 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011722
11723 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
11724
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020011725 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
11726
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011727 ssl opens a ciphered connection
11728
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020011729 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
11730
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020011731 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
11732 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
11733 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11734 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11735
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011736 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
11737 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
11738 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
11739 haproxy -vv.
11740
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011741 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011742
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011743 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
11744 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
11745 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
11746
11747 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
11748 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
11749 of the sequence.
11750
11751 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
11752 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
11753 do.
11754
11755 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11756 unset-var or comment rules.
11757
11758 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011759 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11760 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11761 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11762 option tcp-check
11763 tcp-check connect
11764 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11765 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11766 tcp-check send \r\n
11767 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11768 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11769 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11770 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11771 tcp-check send \r\n
11772 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11773 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11774
11775 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11776 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011777 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011778 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11779 tcp-check connect port 143
11780 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11781 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11782
11783 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11784
11785
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011786tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011787 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011788 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011789 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011790 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011791 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011792 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011793
11794 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011795 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11796
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011797 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11798 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11799 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11800 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11801 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11802 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11803 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11804 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11805 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11806 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11807
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011808 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011809 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11810 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011811 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11812 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11813 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11814
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011815 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11816 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11817 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011818 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11819 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011820 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11821 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011822 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11823 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011824 By default "L7OK" is used.
11825
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011826 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11827 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011828 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
11829 supported :
11830 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11831 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011832 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11833 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11834 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11835 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11836 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011837
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011838 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011839 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011840 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11841 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11842 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11843 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011844 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11845
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011846 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11847 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11848 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11849 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11850
11851 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11852 informational message reported in logs if an error
11853 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11854 log-format string.
11855
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011856 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11857 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11858 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11859 followed by some converters.
11860
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011861 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11862 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11863 with the usual backslash ('\').
11864 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011865 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011866 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11867 used upper or lower case.
11868
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011869 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11870
11871 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11872 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11873 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11874 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11875 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11876 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11877 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11878 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11879
11880 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11881 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11882 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11883 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11884 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11885 expression.
11886
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011887 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11888 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11889 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11890 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11891 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11892 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11893
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011894 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11895 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11896 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11897 this exact hexadecimal string.
11898 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11899
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011900 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11901 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11902 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11903 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11904 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11905 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11906 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11907 size.
11908
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011909 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11910 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11911 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11912 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11913 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11914 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11915 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11916 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11917 in a binary string before matching the response's
11918 buffer.
11919
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011920 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011921 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011922 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11923 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11924 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11925 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11926 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11927 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11928 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11929 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11930 the null character.
11931
11932 Examples :
11933 # perform a POP check
11934 option tcp-check
11935 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11936
11937 # perform an IMAP check
11938 option tcp-check
11939 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11940
11941 # look for the redis master server
11942 option tcp-check
11943 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011944 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011945 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11946 tcp-check expect string role:master
11947 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11948 tcp-check expect string +OK
11949
11950
11951 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011952 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011953
11954
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011955tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11956tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11957 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11958 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011959 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011960 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011961
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011962 Arguments :
11963 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11964
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011965 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11966 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011967
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011968 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11969 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011970
11971 Examples :
11972 # look for the redis master server
11973 option tcp-check
11974 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11975 tcp-check expect string role:master
11976
11977 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011978 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011979
11980
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011981tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11982tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11983 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11984 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011985 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011986 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011987
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011988 Arguments :
11989 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011990
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011991 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11992 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011993
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011994 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
11995 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
11996 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011997
11998 Examples :
11999 # redis check in binary
12000 option tcp-check
12001 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
12002 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
12003
12004
12005 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010012006 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012007
12008
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012009tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012010 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012011 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012012 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012013
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012014 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012015 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12016 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
12017 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
12018 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
12019 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
12020 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
12021 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
12022 and '-'.
12023
12024 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
12025
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012026 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012027 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
12028
12029
12030tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012031 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012032 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012033 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012034
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012035 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012036 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12037 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
12038 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
12039 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
12040 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
12041 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
12042 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
12043 and '-'.
12044
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012045 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012046 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
12047
12048
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012049tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12050 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012051 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12052 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012053 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012054 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12055 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012056
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012057 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012058
12059 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
12060 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012061 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
12062 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
12063 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
12064 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
12065 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
12066 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012067
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012068 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12069 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12070 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
12071 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012072
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020012073 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012074 - accept :
12075 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12076 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12077 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012078
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012079 - reject :
12080 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12081 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12082 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
12083 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
12084 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
12085 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
12086 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
12087 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
12088 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
12089 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
12090 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012091 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012092
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012093 - expect-proxy layer4 :
12094 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
12095 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
12096 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
12097 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
12098 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
12099 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
12100 hosts.
12101
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010012102 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
12103 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
12104 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
12105 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
12106 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
12107 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
12108 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
12109 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
12110
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012111 - capture <sample> len <length> :
12112 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
12113 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
12114 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
12115 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
12116 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
12117 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
12118 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
12119 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020012120 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
12121 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012122
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012123 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012124 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020012125 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
12126 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
12127 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012128 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020012129 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020012130 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
12131 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
12132 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
12133 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
12134 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
12135 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
12136 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012137
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012138 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012139 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012140 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012141 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012142 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
12143 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
12144 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012145
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012146 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
12147 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
12148 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
12149 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012150
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012151 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
12152 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
12153 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
12154 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
12155 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012156 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
12157 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
12158 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
12159 layer7 information is extracted.
12160
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012161 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
12162 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
12163 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
12164 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
12165 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012166
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012167 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12168 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12169 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
12170 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
12171
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012172 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12173 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12174 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
12175 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
12176
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012177 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
12178 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12179 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12180 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12181 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012182
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012183 - set-src <expr> :
12184 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
12185 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
12186 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012187 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012188
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012189 Arguments:
12190 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12191 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012192
12193 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012194 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
12195
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012196 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
12197 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012198
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012199 - set-src-port <expr> :
12200 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
12201 expression.
12202
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012203 Arguments:
12204 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12205 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012206
12207 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012208 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
12209
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012210 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
12211 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
12212 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012213
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012214 - set-dst <expr> :
12215 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
12216 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
12217 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
12218 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12219 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12220
12221 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12222 followed by some converters.
12223
12224 Example:
12225
12226 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
12227 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
12228
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012229 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
12230 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
12231
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012232 - set-dst-port <expr> :
12233 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
12234 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12235 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12236
12237
12238 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12239 followed by some converters.
12240
12241 Example:
12242
12243 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
12244
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012245 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
12246 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
12247 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
12248
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012249 - "silent-drop" :
12250 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012251 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012252 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12253 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12254 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12255 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12256 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012257 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12258 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012259 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12260 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012261 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012262 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12263 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12264 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12265 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12266
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012267 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12268 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12269 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012270
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012271 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12272 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
12273 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012274
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012275 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012276 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012277 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012278
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012279 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
12280 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12281 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012282
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012283 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012284 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12285 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012286
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012287 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
12288
12289 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12290
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012291 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12292
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012293 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012294
12295
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012296tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12297 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012299 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012300 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012301 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12302 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012303
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012304 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012305
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012306 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012307 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12308 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012309 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
12310 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012311
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012312 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
12313 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
12314 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
12315 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012316 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012317 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so HAProxy keeps a record of
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012318 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
12319 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
12320 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
12321 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012322 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012323 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012324
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012325 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12326 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12327 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12328 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012329
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012330 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012331 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012332 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012333 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12334 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012335 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012336 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012337 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012338 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012339 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012340 - set-dst <expr>
12341 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012342 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012343 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012344 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012345 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012346 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012347 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012348
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012349 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
12350 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012351 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
12352 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012353
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012354 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
12355 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
12356 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
12357 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
12358 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
12359 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012360
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012361 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012362 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12363 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012364
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020012365 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
12366 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
12367 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
12368 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
12369 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
12370 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
12371
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012372 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020012373 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
12374 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
12375 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
12376 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
12377 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
12378 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
12379 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
12380 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
12381 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
12382 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012383
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012384 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012385 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
12386 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
12387 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012388
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012389 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
12390 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
12391
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012392 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012393 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
12394 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012395
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012396 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12397 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012398 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012399 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12400 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012401 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012402 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012403 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012404 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12405 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012406 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012407 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12408 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012409
12410 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12411 followed by some converters.
12412
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012413 The "switch-mode" is used to perform a connection upgrade. Only HTTP
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012414 upgrades are supported for now. The protocol may optionally be
12415 specified. This action is only available for a proxy with the frontend
12416 capability. The connection upgrade is immediately performed, following
12417 "tcp-request content" rules are not evaluated. This upgrade method should be
12418 preferred to the implicit one consisting to rely on the backend mode. When
12419 used, it is possible to set HTTP directives in a frontend without any
Ilya Shipitsin3df59892021-05-10 12:50:00 +050012420 warning. These directives will be conditionally evaluated if the HTTP upgrade
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012421 is performed. However, an HTTP backend must still be selected. It remains
12422 unsupported to route an HTTP connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
12423
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010012424 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
12425
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012426 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12427 <var-name>.
12428
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012429 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
12430 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
12431 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
12432 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
12433 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
12434
12435 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
12436 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
12437 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
12438 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
12439 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
12440 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
12441 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
12442 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
12443 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
12444 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
12445 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
12446
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012447 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12448 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12449 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12450 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12451 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12452
12453 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12454
12455 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12456
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012457 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
12458 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
12459 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
12460 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
12461 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
12462 evaluated.
12463
12464 Example:
Aurelien DARRAGONdf332122022-10-05 18:09:33 +020012465 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012466
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012467 Example:
12468
12469 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012470 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012471
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012472 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012473 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012474 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012475 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12476 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020012477 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012478 tcp-request content reject
12479
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012480 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
12481 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
12482 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12483 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12484 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
12485 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
12486 ...
12487 http-request reject unless is_host_com
12488
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012489 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012490 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
12491 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012492 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012493 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012494
12495 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
12496 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012497 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012498 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012499 tcp-request content reject
12500
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012501 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012502 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012503 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012504 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012505 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
12506 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012507
12508 Example:
12509 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12510 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012511 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012512
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012513 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012514 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012515
12516 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012517 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012518 # protecting all our sites
12519 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012520 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12521 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012522 ...
12523 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
12524
12525 backend http_dynamic
12526 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012527 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012528 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012529 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012530 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012531 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012532 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012533
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012534 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012535
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030012536 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
12537 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012538
12539
12540tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
12541 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
12542 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012543 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012544 Arguments :
12545 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12546 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12547 as explained at the top of this document.
12548
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012549 People using HAProxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012550 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
12551 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
12552 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
12553 data for at most the specified amount of time.
12554
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012555 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
12556 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
12557 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
12558 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
12559
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012560 Note that when performing content inspection, HAProxy will evaluate the whole
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012561 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012562 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012563 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012564 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, HAProxy will not wait at all
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010012565 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
12566 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
12567 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012568
Christopher Faulet3e2a39e2023-05-16 08:15:12 +020012569 Note the inspection delay is shortened if an connection error or shutdown is
12570 experienced or if the request buffer appears as full.
12571
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012572 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
12573 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
12574 it pass through unaffected.
12575
12576 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
12577 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
12578 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012579 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012580 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
12581 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020012582 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
12583 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
12584 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012585
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012586 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012587 "timeout client".
12588
12589
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012590tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12591 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
12592 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12593 no | no | yes | yes
12594 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012595 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12596 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012597
12598 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12599
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012600 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012601 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12602 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012603 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
12604 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012605
12606 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
12607
12608 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12609 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12610 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12611 inserted.
12612
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012613 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012614 - accept :
12615 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12616 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12617 the rules evaluation.
12618
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012619 - close :
12620 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
12621 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
12622 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
12623 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
12624 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
12625 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012626 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012627 protocols.
12628
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012629 - reject :
12630 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12631 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012632 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012633
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012634 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Willy Tarreau9de54ba2021-09-02 20:51:21 +020012635 Sets a variable from an expression.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012636
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012637 - unset-var(<var-name>)
12638 Unsets a variable.
12639
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012640 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12641 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12642 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12643 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12644
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012645 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12646 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12647 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12648 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12649
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012650 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12651 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12652 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12653 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12654 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012655
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012656 - "silent-drop" :
12657 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012658 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012659 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12660 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12661 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12662 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12663 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012664 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12665 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012666 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12667 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012668 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012669 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12670 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12671 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12672 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12673
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012674 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12675 Send a group of SPOE messages.
12676
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012677 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12678 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12679 for changing the default action to a reject.
12680
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012681 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
12682 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
12683 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
12684 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012685 period.
12686
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012687 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
12688 declared inline.
12689
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012690 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12691 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012692 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012693 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12694 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012695 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012696 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012697 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012698 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12699 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012700 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012701 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12702 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012703
12704 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12705 followed by some converters.
12706
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012707 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12708 <var-name>.
12709
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012710 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12711 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12712 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12713 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12714 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12715
12716 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12717
12718 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12719
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012720 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12721
12722 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
12723
12724
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012725tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12726 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
12727 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12728 no | yes | yes | no
12729 Arguments :
12730 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12731 below.
12732
12733 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12734
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012735 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012736 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
12737 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
12738 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
12739 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
12740 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
12741 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
12742 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012743 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012744 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
12745 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
12746 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
12747 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
12748 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
12749 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
12750 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
12751 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
12752 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
12753 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
12754 instead.
12755
12756 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12757 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12758 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
12759 rules which may be inserted.
12760
12761 Several types of actions are supported :
12762 - accept : the request is accepted
12763 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12764 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
12765 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012766 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012767 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet57759f32021-06-23 12:19:25 +020012768 - set-dst <expr>
12769 - set-dst-port <expr>
12770 - set-src <expr>
12771 - set-src-port <expr>
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012772 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012773 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012774 - silent-drop
12775
12776 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
12777 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
12778 sections for a complete description.
12779
12780 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12781 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12782 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12783
12784 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12785 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12786 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12787 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12788 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12789
12790 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12791 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12792
12793 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12794 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12795 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12796
12797 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12798 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12799 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12800
12801 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12802 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12803 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12804
12805 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12806 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12807 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12808
12809 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12810
12811 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12812
12813
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012814tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12815 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12816 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12817 no | no | yes | yes
12818 Arguments :
12819 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12820 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12821 as explained at the top of this document.
12822
12823 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12824
12825
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012826timeout check <timeout>
12827 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12828 established.
12829
12830 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12831 yes | no | yes | yes
12832 Arguments:
12833 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12834 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12835 as explained at the top of this document.
12836
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012837 If set, HAProxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012838 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012839 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012840 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012841 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12842 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12843 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012844
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012845 If "timeout check" is not set HAProxy uses "inter" for complete check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012846 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12847
12848 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12849 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012850 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012851
12852 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12853 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12854 forget about it.
12855
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012856 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12857 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012858
12859
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012860timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012861 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12862 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12863 yes | yes | yes | no
12864 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012865 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012866 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12867 as explained at the top of this document.
12868
12869 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12870 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12871 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012872 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12873 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12874 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12875 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012876 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12877 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12878 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012879 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012880 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012881 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12882 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012883 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12884 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012885
12886 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12887 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12888 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12889 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012890 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012891 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12892
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012893 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012894
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012895
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012896timeout client-fin <timeout>
12897 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
12898 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12899 yes | yes | yes | no
12900 Arguments :
12901 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12902 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12903 as explained at the top of this document.
12904
12905 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12906 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12907 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12908 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12909 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
12910 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12911 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010012912 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
12913 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
12914 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012915
12916 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12917 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12918 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
12919
12920 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
12921
12922
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012923timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012924 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
12925 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12926 yes | no | yes | yes
12927 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012928 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012929 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12930 as explained at the top of this document.
12931
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012932 If the server is located on the same LAN as HAProxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012933 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012934 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012935 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012936 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
12937 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012938
12939 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12940 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12941 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12942 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012943 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012944 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12945
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012946 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012947
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012948
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012949timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
12950 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
12951 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12952 yes | yes | yes | yes
12953 Arguments :
12954 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12955 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12956 as explained at the top of this document.
12957
12958 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
12959 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
12960 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
12961 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
12962 once the request has started to present itself.
12963
12964 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
12965 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
12966 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
12967 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
12968 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
12969
12970 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
12971 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
12972 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
12973 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
12974
12975 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
12976 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012977 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012978 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
12979 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012980 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012981
12982 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
12983 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
12984 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
12985 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
12986
12987 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
12988
12989
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012990timeout http-request <timeout>
12991 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
12992 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012993 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012994 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012995 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012996 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12997 as explained at the top of this document.
12998
12999 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
13000 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
13001 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
13002 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
13003 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
13004 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
13005 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020013006 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
13007 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
13008 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
13009 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013010 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013011 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
13012 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013013
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010013014 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
13015 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
13016 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
13017 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
13018 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013019 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013020
13021 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
13022 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013023 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013024 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
13025 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
13026
13027 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020013028 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
13029 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
13030 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013031
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013032 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010013033 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013034
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013035
13036timeout queue <timeout>
13037 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
13038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13039 yes | no | yes | yes
13040 Arguments :
13041 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13042 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13043 as explained at the top of this document.
13044
13045 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
13046 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
13047 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
13048 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
13049 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
13050
13051 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
13052 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
13053 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
13054 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
13055
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013056 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013057
13058
13059timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013060 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
13061 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13062 yes | no | yes | yes
13063 Arguments :
13064 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13065 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13066 as explained at the top of this document.
13067
13068 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13069 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
13070 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
13071 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
13072 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
13073 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
13074 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
13075
13076 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13077 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13078 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
13079 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
13080 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013081 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013082 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013083 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
13084 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013085 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
13086 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013087
13088 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13089 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13090 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13091 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013092 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013093 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13094
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013095 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013096
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013097
13098timeout server-fin <timeout>
13099 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
13100 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13101 yes | no | yes | yes
13102 Arguments :
13103 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13104 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13105 as explained at the top of this document.
13106
13107 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13108 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
13109 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
13110 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
13111 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
13112 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
13113 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
13114 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
13115 situations, it should not be needed.
13116
13117 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13118 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
13119 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
13120
13121 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
13122
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013123
13124timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013125 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013126 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13127 yes | yes | yes | yes
13128 Arguments :
13129 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
13130 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13131 as explained at the top of this document.
13132
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020013133 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
13134 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
13135 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013136
13137 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13138 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13139 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
13140 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013141 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013142
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013143 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013144
13145
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013146timeout tunnel <timeout>
13147 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
13148 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13149 yes | no | yes | yes
13150 Arguments :
13151 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13152 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13153 as explained at the top of this document.
13154
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013155 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013156 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
13157 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
13158 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013159 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
13160 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013161 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
13162 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
13163 specified.
13164
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013165 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
13166 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
13167 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
13168 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
13169 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
13170 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
13171 state.
13172
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013173 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13174 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13175 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
13176 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013177 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013178
13179 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13180 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13181 forget about it.
13182
13183 Example :
13184 defaults http
13185 option http-server-close
13186 timeout connect 5s
13187 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013188 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013189 timeout server 30s
13190 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
13191
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013192 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013193
13194
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013195transparent (deprecated)
13196 Enable client-side transparent proxying
13197 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010013198 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013199 Arguments : none
13200
13201 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
13202 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
13203 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
13204 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
13205 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
13206 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
13207 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
13208 appropriate server.
13209
13210 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
13211
13212 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
13213 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
13214
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013215 See also: "option transparent"
13216
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013217unique-id-format <string>
13218 Generate a unique ID for each request.
13219 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13220 yes | yes | yes | no
13221 Arguments :
13222 <string> is a log-format string.
13223
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013224 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
13225 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
13226 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
13227 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013228
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013229 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013230 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple HAProxy instances
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013231 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
13232 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
13233 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
13234 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
13235 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
13236 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013237
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013238 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
13239 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013240
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013241 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013242
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013243 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013244
13245 will generate:
13246
13247 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13248
13249 See also: "unique-id-header"
13250
13251unique-id-header <name>
13252 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
13253 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13254 yes | yes | yes | no
13255 Arguments :
13256 <name> is the name of the header.
13257
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013258 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
13259 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013260
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013261 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013262
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013263 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013264 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
13265
13266 will generate:
13267
13268 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13269
13270 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013271
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013272use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013273 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013274 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13275 no | yes | yes | no
13276 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013277 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
13278 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013279
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013280 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
13281 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013282
13283 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
13284 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
13285 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013286 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013287 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013288 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
13289 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013290
13291 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
13292 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
13293 assign the backend.
13294
13295 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
13296 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13297 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
13298 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
13299 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
13300 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
13301
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013302 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013303 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013304 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
13305 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
13306 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
13307
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013308 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
13309 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
13310 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
13311 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
13312 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
13313 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
13314 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
13315 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
13316 cannot be forced from the request.
13317
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013318 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013319 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
13320 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
13321
13322 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
13323 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013324
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020013325use-fcgi-app <name>
13326 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
13327 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13328 no | no | yes | yes
13329 Arguments :
13330 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
13331
13332 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013333
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013334use-server <server> if <condition>
13335use-server <server> unless <condition>
13336 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
13337 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13338 no | no | yes | yes
13339 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013340 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
13341 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013342
13343 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
13344
13345 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
13346 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
13347 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
13348
13349 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
13350 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
13351 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
13352 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
13353 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
13354 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
13355 matches will assign the server.
13356
13357 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
13358 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
13359 with the next rules until one matches.
13360
13361 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
13362 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13363 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
13364 according to other persistence mechanisms.
13365
13366 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
13367 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
13368 stripped.
13369
13370 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
13371 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013372 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013373 implicit TLS (also see "req.ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013374 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013375
13376 Example :
13377 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013378 use-server www if { req.ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013379 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013380 use-server mail if { req.ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013381 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013382 use-server imap if { req.ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000013383 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013384 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
13385 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
13386
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013387 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
13388 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
13389 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
13390 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050013391 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013392 and we fall back to load balancing.
13393
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013394 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013395
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013396
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100133975. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013398--------------------------
13399
13400The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
13401depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
13402settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
13403written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
13404described in this section.
13405
13406
134075.1. Bind options
13408-----------------
13409
13410The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
13411as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
13412no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
13413parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
13414while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
13415provided immediately after the setting name.
13416
13417The currently supported settings are the following ones.
13418
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013419accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
13420 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
13421 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
13422 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
13423 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
13424 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
13425 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
13426 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
13427 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
13428 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010013429 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
13430 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
13431 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013432
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013433accept-proxy
13434 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020013435 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
13436 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013437 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
13438 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
13439 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
13440 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013441 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013442 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
13443 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013444 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
13445 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013446
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013447allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010013448 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013449 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013450 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013451 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
13452 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013453
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013454alpn <protocols>
13455 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13456 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13457 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013458 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013459 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013460 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
13461 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13462 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
13463 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
13464 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
13465 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
13466 preference, like below :
13467
13468 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013469
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013470backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010013471 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013472 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
13473
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010013474curves <curves>
13475 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13476 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
13477 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
13478 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
13479 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
13480 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
13481
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013482ecdhe <named curve>
13483 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010013484 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
13485 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013486
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013487ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013488 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13489 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13490 client's certificate.
13491
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013492ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
13493 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13494 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
13495 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
13496 error is ignored.
13497
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013498ca-sign-file <cafile>
13499 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13500 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
13501 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
13502 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13503 'generate-certificates' for details.
13504
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000013505ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013506 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
13507 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
13508 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13509 'generate-certificates' for details.
13510
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013511ca-verify-file <cafile>
13512 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
13513 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
13514 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
13515 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
13516 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
13517
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013518ciphers <ciphers>
13519 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13520 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000013521 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013522 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013523 information and recommendations see e.g.
13524 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13525 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13526 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
13527
13528ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13529 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13530 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
13531 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
13532 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013533 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
13534 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013535
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013536crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013537 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13538 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
Remi Tricot-Le Breton02bd6842021-05-04 12:22:34 +020013539 to verify client's certificate. You need to provide a certificate revocation
13540 list for every certificate of your certificate authority chain.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013541
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013542crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013543 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13544 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
13545 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
13546 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
13547 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010013548 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
13549 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013550
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010013551 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
13552 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
13553
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013554 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
13555 are loaded.
13556
13557 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010013558 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
13559 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
13560 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
13561 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
13562 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
13563 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
13564 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
William Lallemand929da3e2023-04-04 16:28:58 +020013565 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org). If an empty directory is used,
13566 HAProxy will not start unless the "strict-sni" keyword is used.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013567
13568 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
13569 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
13570 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
13571 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010013572 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
13573 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013574
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020013575 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013576
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013577 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013578 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013579 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
13580 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013581 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
13582 clients).
13583
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013584 For each PEM file, HAProxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013585 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
13586 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
13587 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
13588 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
13589 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
13590 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
13591 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
13592 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
13593 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
13594 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
13595 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
13596 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
13597
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013598 For each PEM file, HAProxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013599 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
13600 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
13601 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
13602 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
13603
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050013604 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
13605 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
13606 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
13607 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013608
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013609 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
13610 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
13611 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013612
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013613crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013614 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013615 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013616 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013617 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013618
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013619crt-list <file>
13620 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013621 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
13622 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013623
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013624 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
13625
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020013626 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
13627 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
13628 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
13629 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
13630 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013631
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013632 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013633 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
13634 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
13635 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
13636 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
13637 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013638 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
13639 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
13640 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013641
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013642 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
13643 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
13644 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013645
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013646 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
13647
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013648 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013649 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which HAProxy should use in
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013650 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
13651 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
13652 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
13653 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
13654 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
13655 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013656
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013657 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013658 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013659 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013660 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013661 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013662 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013663
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013664defer-accept
13665 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13666 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
13667 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013668 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013669 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
13670 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
13671 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
13672 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
13673 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
13674 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
13675 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
13676
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013677expose-fd listeners
13678 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
13679 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020013680 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
13681 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013682 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013683
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013684force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013685 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013686 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013687 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013688 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013689
13690force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013691 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013692 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013693 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013694
13695force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013696 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013697 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013698 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013699
13700force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013701 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013702 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013703 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013704
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013705force-tlsv13
13706 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
13707 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013708 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013709
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013710generate-certificates
13711 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13712 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
13713 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
13714 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
13715 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
13716 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
13717 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
13718 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
13719 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
13720 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
13721 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
13722
13723 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
13724 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013725 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013726 certificate is used many times.
13727
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013728gid <gid>
13729 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
13730 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13731 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
13732 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
13733 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13734
13735group <group>
13736 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
13737 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
13738 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
13739 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
13740 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13741
13742id <id>
13743 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
13744 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
13745 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
13746 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
13747
13748interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010013749 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
13750 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
13751 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
13752 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
13753 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
13754 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010013755 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
13756 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
13757 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
13758 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
13759 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
13760 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013761
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013762level <level>
13763 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
13764 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
13765 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013766 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013767 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
13768 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
13769 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013770 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013771 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013772 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013773 all counters).
13774
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020013775severity-output <format>
13776 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
13777 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
13778 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
13779 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
13780 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
13781 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
13782 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
13783 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
13784 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
13785 rfc5424 convention.
13786
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013787maxconn <maxconn>
13788 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13789 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13790 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13791 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13792 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13793 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13794 eat all memory.
13795
13796mode <mode>
13797 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13798 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13799 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13800 UNIX sockets.
13801
13802mss <maxseg>
13803 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13804 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13805 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13806 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13807 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13808 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13809 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13810 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13811 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13812 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13813 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13814
13815name <name>
13816 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13817 page.
13818
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013819namespace <name>
13820 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13821 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13822 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13823 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13824
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013825nice <nice>
13826 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13827 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13828 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13829 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13830 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13831 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13832 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13833 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13834 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13835 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13836 one for an RDP socket.
13837
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013838no-ca-names
13839 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13840 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013841 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013842
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013843no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013844 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013845 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013846 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013847 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013848 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13849 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013850
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013851no-tls-tickets
13852 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13853 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13854 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013855 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13856 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013857 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13858 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13859 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013860
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013861no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013862 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013863 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013864 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013865 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013866 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13867 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013868
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013869no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013870 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013871 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013872 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013873 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013874 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13875 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013876
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013877no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013878 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013879 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013880 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013881 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013882 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13883 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013884
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013885no-tlsv13
13886 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13887 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13888 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13889 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013890 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13891 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013892
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013893npn <protocols>
13894 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13895 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13896 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013897 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013898 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013899 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13900 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
13901 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
13902 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
13903 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013904
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013905prefer-client-ciphers
13906 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
13907 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
13908 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020013909 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
13910 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
13911 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013912
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013913process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013914 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013915 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013916 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013917 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
13918 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
13919 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
13920 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013921 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013922 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
13923 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
13924 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
13925 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
13926 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013927
13928 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
13929
13930 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
13931 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
13932 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
13933 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
13934 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
13935 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
13936 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
13937 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020013938
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013939proto <name>
13940 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
13941 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
13942 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010013943 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
13944 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
13945
13946 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
13947 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
13948 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
13949 also reported (flag=HTX).
13950
13951 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
13952 a bind line :
13953
13954 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
13955 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
13956 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
13957
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013958 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013959 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080013960 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013961 h2" on the bind line.
13962
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013963ssl
13964 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013965 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013966 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
13967 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020013968 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
13969 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013970
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013971ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13972 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013973 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
13974 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
13975 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013976 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13977
13978ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013979 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
13980 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
13981 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
13982 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013983
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010013984strict-sni
13985 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
13986 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
William Lallemand929da3e2023-04-04 16:28:58 +020013987 a certificate. The default certificate is not used. This option also allows
13988 to start without any certificate on a bind line, so an empty directory could
13989 be used and filled later from the stats socket.
13990 See the "crt" option for more information. See "add ssl crt-list" command in
13991 the management guide.
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010013992
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013993tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013994 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013995 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013996 allows HAProxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013997 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013998 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
13999 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
14000 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
14001 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
14002 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
14003 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
14004 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
14005
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014006tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010014007 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014008 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
14009 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
14010 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
14011 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
14012 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
14013 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
14014 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020014015 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
14016 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
14017 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014018
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010014019tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
14020 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010014021 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
14022 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
14023 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
14024 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
14025 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
14026 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
14027 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
14028 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
14029 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
14030 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010014031 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
14032 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
14033
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014034transparent
14035 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
14036 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
14037 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
14038 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
14039 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
14040 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
14041 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
14042 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
14043 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
14044 so check for support with your vendor.
14045
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014046v4v6
14047 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14048 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
14049 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
14050 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014051 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014052
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014053v6only
14054 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14055 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
14056 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014057 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
14058 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014059
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014060uid <uid>
14061 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
14062 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14063 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
14064 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
14065 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14066
14067user <user>
14068 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
14069 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14070 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
14071 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
14072 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14073
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014074verify [none|optional|required]
14075 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
14076 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
14077 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
14078 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
14079 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014080 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
14081 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
14082 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
14083 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014084
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200140855.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014086------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014087
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014088The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
14089which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
14090arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
14091settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
14092after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
14093Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
14094address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014095
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014096 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014097 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014098
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014099Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
14100keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
14101
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014102The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014103
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014104addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014105 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010014106 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14107 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
14108 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
14109 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
14110 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014111
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014112agent-check
14113 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014114 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010014115 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
14116 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
14117 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014118
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014119 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014120 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014121 weight of a server as configured when HAProxy starts. Note that a zero
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020014122 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
14123 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014124
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014125 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
14126 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
14127 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
14128 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
14129 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020014130
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014131 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014132 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014133
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014134 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14135 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
14136 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014137
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014138 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14139 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
14140 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014141
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020014142 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014143 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
14144 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
14145 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
14146 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014147 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014148 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014149
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014150 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
14151 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014152
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014153 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
14154 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
14155 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
14156 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
14157 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
14158 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
14159 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
14160 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
14161 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014162
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014163 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
14164 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014165 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
14166 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
14167 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010014168 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014169
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014170 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014171 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014172
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014173agent-send <string>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014174 If this option is specified, HAProxy will send the given string (verbatim)
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014175 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
14176 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
14177 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
14178 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
14179
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014180agent-inter <delay>
14181 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
14182 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14183
14184 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
14185 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
14186 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
14187 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
14188 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14189 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14190 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14191 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14192 of backends use the same servers.
14193
14194 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
14195
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014196agent-addr <addr>
14197 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
14198
14199 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014200 managing status and weights of servers defined in HAProxy in case you can't
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014201 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
14202 hostname, it will be resolved.
14203
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014204agent-port <port>
14205 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
14206
14207 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
14208
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014209allow-0rtt
14210 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020014211 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
14212 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014213
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014214alpn <protocols>
14215 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
14216 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
14217 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014218 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014219 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
14220 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
14221 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
14222 now obsolete NPN extension.
14223 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
14224 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
14225
14226 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
14227
Amaury Denoyelle69352ec2021-10-18 14:40:29 +020014228 See also "ws" to use an alternative ALPN for websocket streams.
14229
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014230backup
14231 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
14232 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
14233 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
14234 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014235 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
14236 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014237
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014238ca-file <cafile>
14239 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14240 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
14241 server's certificate.
14242
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014243check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014244 This option enables health checks on a server:
14245 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
14246 considered available.
14247 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
14248 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
14249 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
14250 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
14251 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
14252 set.
14253 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
14254 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
14255 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
14256 exchanges succeed.
14257
14258 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
14259 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
14260 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
14261 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
14262 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050014263 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014264 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
14265
14266 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
14267 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
14268
14269 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
14270 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
14271
14272 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
14273 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
14274 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
14275 available.
14276
14277 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
14278 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
14279 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
14280
14281 Example:
14282 # simple tcp check
14283 backend foo
14284 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
14285 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
14286 backend foo
14287 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
14288 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
14289 backend foo
14290 option tcp-check
14291 tcp-check connect
14292 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014293
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020014294check-send-proxy
14295 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
14296 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
14297 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
14298 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
14299 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
14300 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
14301 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
14302
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010014303check-alpn <protocols>
14304 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
14305 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
14306 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
14307
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014308check-proto <name>
14309 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
14310 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
14311 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014312 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
14313 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14314
14315 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14316 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14317 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14318 also reported (flag=HTX).
14319
14320 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
14321 directive on a server line:
14322
14323 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14324 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14325 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14326 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14327
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014328 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014329 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
14330 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
14331
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014332check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014333 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014334 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
14335 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014336
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014337check-ssl
14338 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
14339 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
14340 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
14341 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014342 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014343 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
14344 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014345 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014346 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
14347 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014348
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014349check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014350 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014351 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
14352 for normal traffic.
14353
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014354ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014355 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
14356 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
14357 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014358 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
14359 information and recommendations see e.g.
14360 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
14361 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
14362 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014363
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014364ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
14365 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
14366 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
14367 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
14368 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014369 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
14370 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
14371 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014373cookie <value>
14374 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
14375 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
14376 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
14377 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
14378 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
14379 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
14380 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
14381
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014382crl-file <crlfile>
14383 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14384 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
14385 to verify server's certificate.
14386
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020014387crt <cert>
14388 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14389 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
14390 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
14391 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
14392 certificate request.
14393
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +020014394 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load the key
14395 at the same path suffixed by a ".key" (provided the "ssl-load-extra-files"
14396 option is set accordingly).
14397
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014398disabled
14399 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
14400 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
14401 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
14402 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
14403 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014404 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014405
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014406enabled
14407 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
14408 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
14409 default value.
14410 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
14411 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014412
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014413error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010014414 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
14415 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
14416 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014417
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014418 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014419
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014420fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014421 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
14422 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
14423 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
14424
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014425force-sslv3
14426 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14427 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014428 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014429 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014430
14431force-tlsv10
14432 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014433 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014434 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014435
14436force-tlsv11
14437 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014438 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014439 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014440
14441force-tlsv12
14442 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014443 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014444 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014445
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014446force-tlsv13
14447 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14448 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014449 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014450
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014451id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020014452 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
14453 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
14454 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014455
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014456init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
14457 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
14458 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014459 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014460 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
14461 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
14462 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
14463 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
14464 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
14465 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
14466 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
14467 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
14468 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014469 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014470 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
14471 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
14472 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
14473 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
14474 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
14475 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014476 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014477
14478 Example:
14479 defaults
14480 # never fail on address resolution
14481 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
14482
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014483inter <delay>
14484fastinter <delay>
14485downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014486 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
14487 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14488 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
14489 between checks depending on the server state :
14490
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020014491 Server state | Interval used
14492 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14493 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
14494 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14495 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
14496 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
14497 or yet unchecked. |
14498 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14499 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
14500 | "inter" otherwise.
14501 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014502
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014503 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
14504 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
14505 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
14506 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014507 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14508 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14509 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14510 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14511 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014512
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020014513log-proto <logproto>
14514 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
14515 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
14516 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
14517 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
14518
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014519maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014520 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
14521 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014522 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
14523 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014524 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
14525 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
14526 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
14527 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
14528
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014529 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
14530 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
14531 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
14532 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
14533 than 50 concurrent requests.
14534
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014535maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014536 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
14537 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
14538 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
14539 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020014540 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
14541 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
14542 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
14543 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
14544 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
14545 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
14546 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014547
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010014548max-reuse <count>
14549 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
14550 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
14551 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
14552 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
14553 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
14554 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
14555 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
14556 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
14557
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014558minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014559 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
14560 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
14561 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
14562 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
14563 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
14564 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014565 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014566 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014567
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014568namespace <name>
14569 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14570 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
14571 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14572 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14573
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014574no-agent-check
14575 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
14576 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14577 default value.
14578 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14579 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
14580
14581no-backup
14582 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
14583 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14584 default value.
14585 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14586 "default-server" "backup" setting.
14587
14588no-check
14589 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
14590 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14591 default value.
14592 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14593 "default-server" "check" setting.
14594
14595no-check-ssl
14596 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
14597 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14598 default value.
14599 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14600 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
14601
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014602no-send-proxy
14603 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
14604 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14605 default value.
14606 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14607 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
14608
14609no-send-proxy-v2
14610 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
14611 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14612 default value.
14613 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14614 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
14615
14616no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
14617 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
14618 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14619 default value.
14620 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14621 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
14622
14623no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14624 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
14625 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14626 default value.
14627 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14628 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
14629
14630no-ssl
14631 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
14632 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14633 default value.
14634 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14635 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
14636
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010014637 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
14638 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
14639 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
14640
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010014641no-ssl-reuse
14642 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
14643 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
14644 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
14645 and for paranoid users.
14646
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014647no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014648 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14649 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014650 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014651
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014652 Supported in default-server: No
14653
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014654no-tls-tickets
14655 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14656 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14657 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014658 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
14659 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014660 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14661 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14662 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014663 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014664
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014665no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014666 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014667 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14668 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014669 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14670 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014671 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014672
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014673 Supported in default-server: No
14674
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014675no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014676 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014677 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14678 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014679 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14680 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014681 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014682
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014683 Supported in default-server: No
14684
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014685no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014686 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014687 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14688 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014689 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14690 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014691 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014692
14693 Supported in default-server: No
14694
14695no-tlsv13
14696 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14697 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14698 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
14699 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14700 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014701 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014702
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014703 Supported in default-server: No
14704
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014705no-verifyhost
14706 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
14707 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14708 default value.
14709 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14710 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014711
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014712no-tfo
14713 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
14714 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14715 default value.
14716 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14717 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
14718
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090014719non-stick
14720 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
14721 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
14722 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
14723
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014724npn <protocols>
14725 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14726 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14727 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014728 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014729 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
14730 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14731 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
14732
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014733observe <mode>
14734 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
14735 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
14736 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
14737 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
14738 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
14739 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010014740 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014741
14742 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
14743
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014744on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014745 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
14746 Currently, four modes are available:
14747 - fastinter: force fastinter
14748 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
14749 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
14750 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
14751 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
14752
14753 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
14754
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014755on-marked-down <action>
14756 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
14757 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014758 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
14759 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
14760 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
14761 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
14762 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
14763 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
14764 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
14765 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014766
14767 Actions are disabled by default
14768
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014769on-marked-up <action>
14770 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
14771 Currently one action is available:
14772 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
14773 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
14774 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
14775 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014776 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
14777 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014778 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
14779 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
14780
14781 Actions are disabled by default
14782
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014783pool-low-conn <max>
14784 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
14785 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
14786 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
14787 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
14788 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
14789 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
14790 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
14791 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
14792 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
14793 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010014794 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
14795 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
14796 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
14797 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014798
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010014799pool-max-conn <max>
14800 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
14801 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
14802 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
14803 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
14804 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
14805 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
14806
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014807pool-purge-delay <delay>
14808 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010014809 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020014810 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014811
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014812port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014813 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010014814 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14815 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
14816 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
14817 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
14818 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014819
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014820proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014821 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
14822 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
14823 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014824 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
14825 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14826
14827 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14828 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14829 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14830 also reported (flag=HTX).
14831
14832 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14833 a server line :
14834
14835 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14836 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14837 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14838 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14839
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014840 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014841 protocol for all connections established to this server.
14842
Amaury Denoyelle69352ec2021-10-18 14:40:29 +020014843 See also "ws" to use an alternative protocol for websocket streams.
14844
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014845redir <prefix>
14846 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
14847 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
14848 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
14849 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
14850 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
14851 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
14852 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14853 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014854 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014855 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014856 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14857 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
14858 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
14859 loop between the client and HAProxy!
14860
14861 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
14862
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014863rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014864 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
14865 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
14866 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
14867
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014868resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
14869 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
14870 server.
14871
14872 Available options:
14873
14874 * allow-dup-ip
14875 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
14876 resolution at runtime is in operation.
14877 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
14878 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
14879 For such case, simply enable this option.
14880 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
14881
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050014882 * ignore-weight
14883 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
14884 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
14885 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
14886
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014887 * prevent-dup-ip
14888 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
14889 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
14890 same fqdn.
14891 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
14892
14893 Example:
14894 backend b_myapp
14895 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
14896 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14897 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14898
14899 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
14900 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
14901 it
14902 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
14903 different address
14904
14905 Default value: not set
14906
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014907resolve-prefer <family>
14908 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
14909 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
14910 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
14911 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
14912
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020014913 Default value: ipv6
14914
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014915 Example:
14916
14917 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014918
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014919resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014920 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014921 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014922 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014923 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
14924 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014925 configured network, another address is selected.
14926
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014927 Example:
14928
14929 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014930
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014931resolvers <id>
14932 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
14933 hostname.
14934
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014935 Example:
14936
14937 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014938
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014939 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014940
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014941send-proxy
14942 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
14943 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
14944 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
14945 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014946 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
14947 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
14948 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
14949 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014950 fully be chained to another instance of HAProxy listening with an
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014951 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
14952 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
14953 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
14954 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
14955 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014956 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
14957 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014958
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014959send-proxy-v2
14960 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
14961 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14962 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14963 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020014964 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
14965 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
14966 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
14967 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014968
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014969proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010014970 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
14971 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
14972
14973 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
14974 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
14975 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
14976 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
14977 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
14978 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
14979 connection is supported).
14980 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
14981 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
14982 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
14983 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
14984 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
14985 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
14986 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014987
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014988send-proxy-v2-ssl
14989 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14990 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14991 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14992 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14993 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14994 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
14995 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014996 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
14997 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014998
14999send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
15000 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
15001 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
15002 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
15003 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
15004 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
15005 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
15006 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
15007 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015008 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
15009 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015010
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015011slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015012 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
15013 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
15014 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
15015 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
15016 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
15017 parameters :
15018
15019 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
15020 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
15021
15022 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
15023 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
15024 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
15025 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
15026
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015027 The slowstart never applies when HAProxy starts, otherwise it would cause
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015028 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
15029 seen as failed.
15030
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020015031sni <expression>
15032 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
15033 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
15034 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
Willy Tarreau000d4002022-11-25 10:12:12 +010015035 a bridged TCP/SSL scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
15036 expression. THIS MUST NOT BE USED FOR HTTPS, where req.hdr(host) should be
15037 used instead, since SNI in HTTPS must always match the Host field and clients
15038 are allowed to use different host names over the same connection). If
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020015039 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015040 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010015041 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
15042 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020015043
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015044source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020015045source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015046source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015047 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
15048 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
15049 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
15050 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
15051
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015052 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
15053 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
15054 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
15055 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
15056 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
15057 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
15058 server.
15059
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000015060 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
15061 specifying the source address without port(s).
15062
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015063ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020015064 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
15065 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
15066 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
15067 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
15068 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
15069 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015070 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
15071 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015072
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015073ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15074 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
15075 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15076 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
15077
15078ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15079 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
15080 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15081 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
15082
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015083ssl-reuse
15084 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
15085 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15086 default value.
15087 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15088 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
15089
15090stick
15091 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
15092 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15093 default value.
15094 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15095 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015096
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015097socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015098 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015099 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
15100 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
15101
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015102tcp-ut <delay>
15103 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015104 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows HAProxy to
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015105 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015106 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015107 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
15108 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
15109 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
15110 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
15111 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
15112 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
15113 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
15114 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
15115 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
15116
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015117tfo
15118 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
15119 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
15120 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
15121 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015122 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or HAProxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020015123 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015124
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015125track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020015126 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
15127 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
15128 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
15129 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015130 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
15131
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015132tls-tickets
15133 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
15134 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15135 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010015136 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
15137 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
15138 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015139 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010015140 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015141
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015142verify [none|required]
15143 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010015144 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015145 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
15146 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015147 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015148 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
15149 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
15150 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
15151 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
15152 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
15153 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
15154 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
15155 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015156
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015157verifyhost <hostname>
15158 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015159 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
15160 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
15161 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
15162 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
15163 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
15164 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
15165 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
15166 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015167
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015168weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015169 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
15170 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
15171 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020015172 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
15173 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
15174 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
15175 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
15176 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
15177 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015178
Amaury Denoyelle69352ec2021-10-18 14:40:29 +020015179ws { auto | h1 | h2 }
15180 This option allows to configure the protocol used when relaying websocket
15181 streams. This is most notably useful when using an HTTP/2 backend without the
15182 support for H2 websockets through the RFC8441.
15183
15184 The default mode is "auto". This will reuse the same protocol as the main
15185 one. The only difference is when using ALPN. In this case, it can try to
15186 downgrade the ALPN to "http/1.1" only for websocket streams if the configured
15187 server ALPN contains it.
15188
15189 The value "h1" is used to force HTTP/1.1 for websockets streams, through ALPN
15190 if SSL ALPN is activated for the server. Similarly, "h2" can be used to
15191 force HTTP/2.0 websockets. Use this value with care : the server must support
15192 RFC8441 or an error will be reported by haproxy when relaying websockets.
15193
15194 Note that NPN is not taken into account as its usage has been deprecated in
15195 favor of the ALPN extension.
15196
15197 See also "alpn" and "proto".
15198
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015199
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200152005.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
15201-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015202
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015203HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
15204using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070015205configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015206This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
15207can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
15208workload.
15209This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
15210resolution at run time.
15211Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
15212carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
15213
15214
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200152155.3.1. Global overview
15216----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015217
15218As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
15219different steps of the process life:
15220
15221 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
15222 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
15223 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
15224
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015225 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
15226 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015227
15228A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
15229 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
15230 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
15231 resolution to know this new IP.
15232
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015233When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015234HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015235SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
15236from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015237will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, HAProxy
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015238will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020015239
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015240A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015241 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015242 first valid response.
15243
15244 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
15245 servers return an error.
15246
15247
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200152485.3.2. The resolvers section
15249----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015250
15251This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015252HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
15253contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015254
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015255When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
15256uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
15257is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
15258answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
15259
15260When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015261used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015262
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015263 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
15264 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
15265 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015266
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015267 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
15268 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015269
Thierry Fournierfc13f792021-12-15 19:03:52 +010015270 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retries> times. If no valid
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015271 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
15272 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015273
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015274For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
15275following scenarios are possible:
15276
15277 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
15278 ignored
15279
15280 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
15281 applied
15282
15283 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
15284 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
15285
15286 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
15287 retries the query with a new type
15288
15289 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
15290 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015291
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015292As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, HAProxy keeps
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015293a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015294<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015295
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015296
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015297resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015298 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015299
15300A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
15301
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015302accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015303 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015304 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015305 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
15306 by RFC 6891)
15307
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010015308 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
15309 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
15310 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
15311 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
15312 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
15313 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020015314
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015315nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
15316 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
15317 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
15318 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
15319 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
15320 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
15321 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
15322 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
15323 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
15324 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010015325 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
15326
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015327parse-resolv-conf
15328 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
15329 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
15330 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
15331
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015332hold <status> <period>
Christopher Fauletcd978582023-02-27 17:53:31 +010015333 Upon receiving the DNS response <status>, determines whether a server's state
15334 should change from UP to DOWN. To make that determination, it checks whether
15335 any valid status has been received during the past <period> in order to
15336 counteract the just received invalid status.
15337
15338 <status> : last name resolution status.
15339 nx After receiving an NXDOMAIN status, check for any valid
15340 status during the concluding period.
15341
15342 refused After receiving a REFUSED status, check for any valid
15343 status during the concluding period.
15344
15345 timeout After the "timeout retry" has struck, check for any
15346 valid status during the concluding period.
15347
15348 other After receiving any other invalid status, check for any
15349 valid status during the concluding period.
15350
15351 valid Applies only to "http-request do-resolve" and
15352 "tcp-request content do-resolve" actions. It defines the
15353 period for which the server will maintain a valid response
15354 before triggering another resolution. It does not affect
15355 dynamic resolution of servers.
15356
15357 obsolete Defines how long to wait before removing obsolete DNS
15358 records after an updated answer record is received. It
15359 applies to SRV records.
15360
15361 <period> : Amount of time into the past during which a valid response must
15362 have been received. It follows the HAProxy time format and is in
15363 milliseconds by default.
15364
15365 For a server that relies on dynamic DNS resolution to determine its IP
15366 address, receiving an invalid DNS response, such as NXDOMAIN, will lead to
15367 changing the server's state from UP to DOWN. The hold directives define how
15368 far into the past to look for a valid response. If a valid response has been
15369 received within <period>, the just received invalid status will be ignored.
15370
15371 Unless a valid response has been receiving during the concluding period, the
15372 server will be marked as DOWN. For example, if "hold nx 30s" is set and the
15373 last received DNS response was NXDOMAIN, the server will be marked DOWN
15374 unless a valid response has been received during the last 30 seconds.
15375
15376 A server in the DOWN state will be marked UP immediately upon receiving a
15377 valid status from the DNS server.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015378
Christopher Fauletcd978582023-02-27 17:53:31 +010015379 A separate behavior exists for "hold valid" and "hold obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015380
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015381resolve_retries <nb>
15382 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
15383 giving up.
15384 Default value: 3
15385
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015386 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
15387 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
15388 type.
15389
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015390timeout <event> <time>
15391 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
15392 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
15393 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015394 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
15395 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015396 Default value: 1s
15397 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015398 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015399 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015400 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15401 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
15402
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015403 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015404
15405 resolvers mydns
15406 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
15407 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015408 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015409 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015410 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015411 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015412 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015413 hold other 30s
15414 hold refused 30s
15415 hold nx 30s
15416 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015417 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015418 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015419
15420
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200154216. Cache
15422---------
15423
15424HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
15425(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
15426RAM.
15427
15428The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
15429this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
15430
15431If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
15432independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
15433when we try to allocate a new one.
15434
15435The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
15436
15437It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
15438"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
15439for more details.
15440
15441When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
15442replaced by "<CACHE>".
15443
15444
154456.1. Limitation
15446----------------
15447
15448The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
15449
15450- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010015451- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
15452 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
15453 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015454- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
15455- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010015456- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
15457 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
15458 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015459- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
15460 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010015461- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
15462 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
15463 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015464
15465- If the request is not a GET
15466- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
15467- If the request contains an Authorization header
15468
15469
154706.2. Setup
15471-----------
15472
15473To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
15474the corresponding http-request and response actions.
15475
15476
154776.2.1. Cache section
15478---------------------
15479
15480cache <name>
15481 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
15482 size of cache is mandatory.
15483
15484total-max-size <megabytes>
15485 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
15486 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
15487
15488max-object-size <bytes>
15489 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
15490 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
15491 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
15492
15493max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015494 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015495 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
15496 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
15497 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
15498 default.
15499
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015500process-vary <on/off>
15501 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015502 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
15503 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
15504 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015505 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015506
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015507max-secondary-entries <number>
15508 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
15509 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
15510 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
15511
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015512
155136.2.2. Proxy section
15514---------------------
15515
15516http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15517 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
15518 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
15519 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
15520 after this one.
15521
15522http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15523 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
15524 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
15525 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
15526 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
15527
15528
15529Example:
15530
15531 backend bck1
15532 mode http
15533
15534 http-request cache-use foobar
15535 http-response cache-store foobar
15536 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
15537
15538 cache foobar
15539 total-max-size 4
15540 max-age 240
15541
15542
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200155437. Using ACLs and fetching samples
15544----------------------------------
15545
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015546HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015547client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
15548The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
15549these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
15550but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
15551data called patterns.
15552
15553
155547.1. ACL basics
15555---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015556
15557The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
15558content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
15559from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
15560simple :
15561
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015562 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015563 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015564 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
15565 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015566
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015567The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
15568adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015569
15570In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
15571
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015572 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015573
15574This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
15575Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
15576and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015577an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
15578conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
15579as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
15580are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015581
15582ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
15583'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
15584which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
15585
15586There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
15587performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
15588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015589The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
15590specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
15591this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015592methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
15593ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015594
15595Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
15596 - boolean
15597 - integer (signed or unsigned)
15598 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
15599 - string
15600 - data block
15601
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015602Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
15603converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
15604would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
15605The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
15606which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
15607
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015608Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
15609keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
15610fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
15611which are summarized in the table below :
15612
15613 +---------------------+-----------------+
15614 | Sample or converter | Default |
15615 | output type | matching method |
15616 +---------------------+-----------------+
15617 | boolean | bool |
15618 +---------------------+-----------------+
15619 | integer | int |
15620 +---------------------+-----------------+
15621 | ip | ip |
15622 +---------------------+-----------------+
15623 | string | str |
15624 +---------------------+-----------------+
15625 | binary | none, use "-m" |
15626 +---------------------+-----------------+
15627
15628Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
15629matching method, see below.
15630
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015631The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
15632 - boolean
15633 - integer or integer range
15634 - IP address / network
15635 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
15636 - regular expression
15637 - hex block
15638
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015639The following ACL flags are currently supported :
15640
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015641 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
15642 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015643 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015644 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015645 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015646 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015647 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
15648
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015649The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
15650read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
15651if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
15652lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
15653will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
15654beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015655a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, HAProxy may load the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015656lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
15657exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
15658
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015659The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
15660parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
15661ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
15662a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
15663check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
15664
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015665The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
15666socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
15667file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
15668
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015669Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
15670loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
15671
15672 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
15673
15674In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
15675the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
15676case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
15677as well.
15678
15679The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
15680sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
15681do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
15682methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
15683is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015684obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015685followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
15686default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
15687that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
15688string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
15689
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015690The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
15691By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
15692string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
15693resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015694server is not reachable, the HAProxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015695waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015696flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
15697function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
15698
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015699There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
15700sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
15701be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015702
15703 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
15704 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015705 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
15706 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
15707 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
15708 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015709
15710 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
15711 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015712 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015713
15714 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015715 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015716
15717 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015718 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015719
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015720 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015721 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
15722
15723 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
15724 binary or string samples.
15725
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015726 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
15727 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015728
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015729 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
15730 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
15731 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015732
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015733 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
15734 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015736 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
15737 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015738
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015739 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
15740 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015741
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015742 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
15743 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015744 This may be used with binary or string samples.
15745
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015746 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
15747 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
15748 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015749
15750For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
15751request, it is possible to do :
15752
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015753 acl jsess_present req.cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015754
15755In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
15756buffer, one would use the following acl :
15757
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015758 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015759
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015760On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
15761possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
15762
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015763 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015764
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015765All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
15766criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
15767method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
Willy Tarreauedbeab12022-11-25 10:49:41 +010015768to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. This matching method is only
15769usable when the keyword is used alone, without any converter. In case any such
15770converter were to be applied after such an ACL keyword, the default matching
15771method from the ACL keyword is simply ignored since what will matter for the
15772matching is the output type of the last converter. Since all ACL-specific
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015773criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
15774the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015775
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015776If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015777the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
15778For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015779
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015780 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
15781 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
15782 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
15783 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015784
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015785
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015786The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
15787types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
15788combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
15789brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
15790default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015791
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015792 +-------------------------------------------------+
15793 | Input sample type |
15794 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015795 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015796 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15797 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
15798 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015799 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015800 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015801 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015802 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015803 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015804 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015805 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015806 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015807 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015808 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015809 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015810 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015811 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015812 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015813 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015814 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015815 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015816 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015817 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015818 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015819 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015820 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15821 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
15822 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015823
15824
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158257.1.1. Matching booleans
15826------------------------
15827
15828In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
15829Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
15830When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
15831that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
15832
15833Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
15834return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
15835"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
15836
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015837
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158387.1.2. Matching integers
15839------------------------
15840
15841Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
15842enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
15843to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
15844
15845Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
15846matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
15847lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015848
15849For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
15850unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
15851representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
15852
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015853As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
15854two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
15855instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
15856ranges and operators.
15857
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015858For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015859operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
15860Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
15861of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015862
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015863Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015864
15865 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
15866 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
15867 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
15868 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
15869 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
15870
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015871For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015872
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015873 acl negative-length req.hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015874
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015875This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
15876
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015877 acl sslv3 req.ssl_ver 3:3.1
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015878
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015879
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158807.1.3. Matching strings
15881-----------------------
15882
15883String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
15884different forms :
15885
15886 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015887 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015888
15889 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015890 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015891
15892 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
15893 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15894
15895 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
15896 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15897
Willy Tarreau71e58732022-11-25 12:02:25 +010015898 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up anywhere inside the
15899 extracted string, delimited with slashes ("/"), the beginning or the end
15900 of the string. The ACL matches if any of them matches. As such, the string
15901 "/images/png/logo/32x32.png", would match "/images", "/images/png",
15902 "images/png", "/png/logo", "logo/32x32.png" or "32x32.png" but not "png"
15903 nor "32x32".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015904
Willy Tarreau71e58732022-11-25 12:02:25 +010015905 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up anywhere inside the
15906 extracted string, delimited with dots ("."), colons (":"), slashes ("/"),
15907 question marks ("?"), the beginning or the end of the string. This is made
15908 to be used with URLs. Leading and trailing delimiters in the pattern are
15909 ignored. The ACL matches if any of them matches. As such, in the example
15910 string "http://www1.dc-eu.example.com:80/blah", the patterns "http",
15911 "www1", ".www1", "dc-eu", "example", "com", "80", "dc-eu.example",
15912 "blah", ":www1:", "dc-eu.example:80" would match, but not "eu" nor "dc".
15913 Using it to match domain suffixes for filtering or routing is generally
15914 not a good idea, as the routing could easily be fooled by prepending the
15915 matching prefix in front of another domain for example.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015916
15917String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
15918exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
15919characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
15920string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
15921to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015922before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015923
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010015924Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
15925(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
15926Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
15927
15928Example:
15929 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
15930 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
15931
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015932
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200159337.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
15934---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015935
15936Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
15937they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
15938possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
15939passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
15940the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015941the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
15942match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015943
15944
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200159457.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
15946-------------------------------------
15947
15948It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
15949not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
15950a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
15951to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
15952digits may be used upper or lower case.
15953
15954Example :
15955 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015956 acl hello req.payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015957
15958
159597.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
15960---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015961
15962IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
15963netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
15964within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010015965host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015966difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
15967at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
15968does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
15969parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015970
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020015971The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
15972abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
15973
15974 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15975 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
15976 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15977 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
15978 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
15979 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
15980 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
15981 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15982
15983Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
15984192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
15985
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015986IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
15987Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
15988trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
15989IPv6 patterns.
15990
15991HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
15992following situations :
15993 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
15994 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
15995 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
15996 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
15997 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
15998 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
15999 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
16000 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
16001 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
16002 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
16003
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016004
160057.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
16006----------------------------------
16007
16008Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
16009combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
16010
16011 - AND (implicit)
16012 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
16013 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016014
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016015A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016016
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016017 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020016018
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016019Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
16020indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020016021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016022For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
16023"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
16024requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
16025is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
16026
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016027 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016028 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
16029 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
16030 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016031
16032To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
16033and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
16034
16035 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
16036 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
16037 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
16038 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
16039
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016040 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016041 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
16042 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
16043 use_backend www if host_www
16044
16045It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
16046expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
16047be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
16048the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
16049
16050 The following rule :
16051
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016052 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016053 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016054
16055 Can also be written that way :
16056
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016057 http-request deny if METH_POST { req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016058
16059It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
16060to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
16061simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
16062sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
16063good use is the following :
16064
16065 With named ACLs :
16066
16067 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
16068 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
16069 monitor fail if site_dead
16070
16071 With anonymous ACLs :
16072
16073 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
16074
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016075See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
16076keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016077
16078
160797.3. Fetching samples
16080---------------------
16081
16082Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
16083against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
16084sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
16085ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
16086of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
16087available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
16088
16089This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
16090Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
16091compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
16092deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
16093
16094The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
16095matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
16096method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
16097indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
16098
16099As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
16100when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
16101mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
16102the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
16103ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
16104
16105Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
16106multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
16107when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016108incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
16109are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016110is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
16111all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
16112
16113Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
16114 - name
16115 - name(arg1)
16116 - name(arg1,arg2)
16117
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016118
161197.3.1. Converters
16120-----------------
16121
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016122Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
16123of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
16124is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
16125was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016126has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016127unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
16128
16129These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
16130sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
16131the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016132support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016133
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016134A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
16135support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
16136supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
16137(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
16138bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
16139
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016140The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016141
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001614251d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
16143 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16144 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16145 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
16146 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16147 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16148
16149 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016150 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
16151 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000016152 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
16153 frontend http-in
16154 bind *:8081
16155 default_backend servers
16156 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16157 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16158
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016159add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016160 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016161 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016162 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
16163 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016164 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016165 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16166 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16167 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16168 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016169 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016170 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016171
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010016172aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
16173 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
16174 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
16175 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
16176 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
16177 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
16178 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
16179
16180 Example:
16181 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
16182 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
16183
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016184and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016185 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016186 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016187 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16188 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016189 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016190 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16191 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16192 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16193 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016194 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016195 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016196
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016197b64dec
16198 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
16199 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016200 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
16201 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016202
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016203base64
16204 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016205 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016206 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
16207 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016208
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016209bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016210 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016211 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016212 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016213 presence of a flag).
16214
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016215bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
16216 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
16217 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016218 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016219
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016220concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
16221 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
16222 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
16223 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
16224 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
16225 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
16226 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
16227 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
16228 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
16229 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
16230 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016231 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040016232 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016233 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
16234 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016235
16236 Example:
16237 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
16238 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
16239 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016240 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016241 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
16242
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016243cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016244 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
16245 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016246
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016247crc32([<avalanche>])
16248 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
16249 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16250 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16251 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16252 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16253 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
16254 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
16255 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
16256 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
16257 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016258 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
16259
16260crc32c([<avalanche>])
16261 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
16262 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16263 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16264 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
16265 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
16266 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
16267 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
16268 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016269
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020016270cut_crlf
16271 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
16272 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
16273 updated.
16274
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010016275da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016276 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
16277 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
16278 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
16279 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016280 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the HAProxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016281 configuration language.
16282
16283 Example:
16284 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016285 bind *:8881
16286 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000016287 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016288
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010016289debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
16290 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
16291 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
16292 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
16293 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
16294 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
16295 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
16296 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
16297 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
16298 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
16299 printable sample types.
16300
16301 Example:
16302 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020016303
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016304digest(<algorithm>)
16305 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
16306 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
16307
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016308 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016309 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16310
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016311div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016312 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16313 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016314 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016315 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
16316 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016317 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016318 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16319 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16320 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16321 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016322 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016323 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016324
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016325djb2([<avalanche>])
16326 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
16327 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16328 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16329 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16330 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16331 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16332 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016333 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
16334 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016335
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016336even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016337 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016338 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
16339
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016340field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16341 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
16342 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
16343 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
16344 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
16345 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
16346 fields.
16347
16348 Example :
16349 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
16350 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16351 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
16352 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
16353 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010016354
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016355fix_is_valid
16356 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
16357 Information eXchange):
16358
16359 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
16360 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050016361 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016362 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010016363 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016364 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
16365 checksum
16366
16367 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16368 the server can be parsed.
16369
16370 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
16371 message, false if not.
16372
16373 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
16374
16375 Example:
16376 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16377 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16378
16379fix_tag_value(<tag>)
16380 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
16381 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
16382 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
16383 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050016384 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016385 added.
16386
16387 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16388 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
16389 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
16390 fix_is_valid converter.
16391
16392 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
16393
16394 Example:
16395 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16396 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16397 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
16398 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
16399 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
16400
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016401hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016402 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016403 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016404 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016405 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010016406
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016407hex2i
16408 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016409 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016410
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020016411htonl
16412 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
16413 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
16414 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
16415 unsigned 32-bit integer.
16416
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016417hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016418 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
16419 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
16420 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
16421 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
16422
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016423 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016424 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16425
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016426http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016427 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16428 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016429 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
16430 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
16431 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
16432 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
16433 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
16434 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
16435 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
16436 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016437
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016438iif(<true>,<false>)
16439 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
16440 string otherwise.
16441
16442 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020016443 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016444
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016445in_table(<table>)
16446 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16447 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
16448 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016449 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016450 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
16451
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016452ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016453 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016454 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016455 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
16456 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
16457 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
16458 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
16459 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016460
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016461json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016462 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016463 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016464 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016465 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
16466 of errors:
16467 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
16468 bytes, ...)
16469 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
16470 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
16471
16472 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
16473 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
16474 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
16475 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
16476 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
16477 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016478 - "ascii" : never fails;
16479 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
16480 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016481 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016482 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016483 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
16484 characters corresponding to the other errors.
16485
16486 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016487 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016488
16489 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016490 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016491 capture request header user-agent len 150
16492 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016493
16494 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
16495 GET / HTTP/1.0
16496 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
16497
16498 Output log:
16499 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
16500
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020016501json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
16502 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
16503 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
16504 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
16505 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
16506
16507 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
16508 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
16509
16510 Example:
16511 # get a integer value from the request body
16512 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
16513 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
16514
16515 # get a key with '.' in the name
16516 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
16517 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
16518
16519 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
16520 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
16521
16522 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
16523 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
16524
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016525language(<value>[,<default>])
16526 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
16527 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
16528 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
16529 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
16530 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
16531 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
16532 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
16533 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
16534 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016535 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016536 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
16537 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016538
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016539 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016540
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016541 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
16542 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016543
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016544 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
16545 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
16546 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
16547 use_backend spanish if es
16548 use_backend french if fr
16549 use_backend english if en
16550 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016551
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010016552length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010016553 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
16554 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16555 type. The result is of type integer.
16556
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016557lower
16558 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
16559 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16560 type. The result is of type string.
16561
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016562ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
16563 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16564 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
16565 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16566 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16567 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16568 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
16569
16570 Example :
16571
16572 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016573 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016574 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16575
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020016576ltrim(<chars>)
16577 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
16578 representation of the input sample.
16579
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016580map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16581map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16582map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16583 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
16584 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
16585 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
16586 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
16587 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
16588 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
16589 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
16590 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016591
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016592 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
16593 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
16594 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016595
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016596 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016597 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016598
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016599 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
16600 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16601 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
16602 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020016603 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
16604 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016605 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
16606 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16607 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
16608 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16609 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
16610 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16611 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
16612 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080016613 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
16614 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16615 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016616 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16617 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
16618 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16619 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
16620 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016621
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010016622 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
16623 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
16624 the corresponding match text.
16625
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016626 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
16627 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
16628 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
16629 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
16630 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016631
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016632 Example :
16633
16634 # this is a comment and is ignored
16635 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
16636 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
16637 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
16638 | | | `---------- value
16639 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
16640 | `---------------------------- key
16641 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
16642
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016643mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016644 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16645 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016646 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016647 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016648 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016649 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16650 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16651 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16652 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016653 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016654 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016655
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020016656mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016657 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
16658 <packettype>.
16659 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
16660 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
16661 from.
16662 Supported string and integers can be found here:
16663 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
16664 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
16665
16666 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
16667 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
16668 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
16669 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
16670
16671 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
16672 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
16673 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16674 packets only):
16675 17: Session Expiry Interval
16676 33: Receive Maximum
16677 39: Maximum Packet Size
16678 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16679 25: Request Response Information
16680 23: Request Problem Information
16681 21: Authentication Method
16682 22: Authentication Data
16683 18: Will Delay Interval
16684 1: Payload Format Indicator
16685 2: Message Expiry Interval
16686 3: Content Type
16687 8: Response Topic
16688 9: Correlation Data
16689 Not supported yet:
16690 38: User Property
16691
16692 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
16693 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16694 packets only):
16695 17: Session Expiry Interval
16696 33: Receive Maximum
16697 36: Maximum QoS
16698 37: Retain Available
16699 39: Maximum Packet Size
16700 18: Assigned Client Identifier
16701 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16702 31: Reason String
16703 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
16704 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
16705 42: Shared Subscription Available
16706 19: Server Keep Alive
16707 26: Response Information
16708 28: Server Reference
16709 21: Authentication Method
16710 22: Authentication Data
16711 Not supported yet:
16712 38: User Property
16713
16714 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16715 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16716 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16717 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16718
16719 Example:
16720
16721 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16722 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16723 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
16724 if data_in_buffer
16725 # do the same as above
16726 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16727 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
16728 if data_in_buffer
16729
16730mqtt_is_valid
16731 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
16732
16733 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16734 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16735 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16736 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16737
Christopher Fauletc7907732022-03-22 09:41:11 +010016738 Only MQTT 3.1, 3.1.1 and 5.0 are supported.
16739
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016740 Example:
16741
16742 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
Daniel Corbettcc9d9b02021-05-13 10:46:07 -040016743 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid }
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016744
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016745mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016746 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020016747 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
16748 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016749 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016750 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016751 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016752 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16753 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16754 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16755 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016756 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016757 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016758
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010016759nbsrv
16760 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
16761 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
16762 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
16763 map lookup.
16764
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016765neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016766 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
16767 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
16768 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
16769 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016770
16771not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016772 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016773 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016774 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016775 absence of a flag).
16776
16777odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016778 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016779 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
16780
16781or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016782 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016783 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016784 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16785 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016786 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016787 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16788 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16789 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16790 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016791 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016792 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016793
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016794protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
16795 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
16796 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
16797 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
16798 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
16799 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16800 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16801 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16802 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
16803 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
16804 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16805 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
16806
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010016807regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016808 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
16809 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
16810 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
16811 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
16812 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
16813 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
16814 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
16815 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
16816 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016817 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
16818 of characters with other ones.
16819
16820 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
16821 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
16822 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
16823 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
16824 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
16825 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016826
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016827 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016828
16829 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
16830 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
16831 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016832 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016833
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016834 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
16835 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
16836
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016837 # capture groups and backreferences
16838 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020016839 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016840 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
16841
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016842capture-req(<id>)
16843 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
16844 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16845
16846 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016847 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16848 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016849
16850capture-res(<id>)
16851 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
16852 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16853
16854 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016855 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16856 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016857
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020016858rtrim(<chars>)
16859 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
16860 of the input sample.
16861
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016862sdbm([<avalanche>])
16863 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
16864 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16865 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16866 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16867 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16868 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16869 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016870 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
16871 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016872
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016873secure_memcmp(<var>)
16874 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
16875 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
16876 match.
16877
16878 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
16879 performed in constant time.
16880
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016881 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016882 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16883
16884 Example :
16885
16886 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
16887 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
16888 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
16889 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
16890
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016891set-var(<var>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016892 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
16893 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
16894 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016895 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016896 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16897 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016898 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016899 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16900 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016901 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016902 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016903
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016904sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016905 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016906 sample with length of 20 bytes.
16907
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016908sha2([<bits>])
16909 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
16910 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
16911
16912 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
16913 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
16914
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016915 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016916 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16917
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020016918srv_queue
16919 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
16920 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
16921 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
16922 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
16923 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
16924
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016925strcmp(<var>)
16926 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
16927 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
16928 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
16929 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
16930 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
16931 shorter).
16932
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016933 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
16934 strings in constant time.
16935
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016936 Example :
16937
16938 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
16939 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
16940 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
16941
16942
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016943sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016944 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
16945 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016946 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016947 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
16948 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016949 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016950 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16951 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016952 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016953 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16954 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016955 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016956 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016957
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016958table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
16959 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16960 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16961 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
16962 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16963 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16964 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
16965
16966
16967table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
16968 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16969 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16970 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
16971 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16972 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16973 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
16974
16975table_conn_cnt(<table>)
16976 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16977 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016978 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016979 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
16980 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16981
16982table_conn_cur(<table>)
16983 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16984 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16985 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16986 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16987 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
16988
16989table_conn_rate(<table>)
16990 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16991 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16992 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
16993 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16994 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
16995
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016996table_gpt0(<table>)
16997 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16998 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
16999 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
17000 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
17001 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
17002
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017003table_gpc0(<table>)
17004 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17005 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17006 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
17007 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
17008 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
17009
17010table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
17011 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17012 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17013 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
17014 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
17015 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
17016 sample fetch keyword.
17017
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017018table_gpc1(<table>)
17019 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17020 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17021 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
17022 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
17023 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
17024
17025table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
17026 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17027 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17028 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
17029 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
17030 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
17031 sample fetch keyword.
17032
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017033table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
17034 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17035 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017036 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017037 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
17038 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17039
17040table_http_err_rate(<table>)
17041 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17042 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17043 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
17044 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
17045 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
17046 keyword.
17047
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017048table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
17049 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17050 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17051 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
17052 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
17053 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17054
17055table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
17056 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17057 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17058 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
17059 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
17060 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
17061 keyword.
17062
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017063table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
17064 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17065 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017066 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017067 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
17068 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17069
17070table_http_req_rate(<table>)
17071 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17072 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17073 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
17074 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
17075 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
17076 keyword.
17077
17078table_kbytes_in(<table>)
17079 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17080 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017081 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017082 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
17083 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
17084 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
17085 keyword.
17086
17087table_kbytes_out(<table>)
17088 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17089 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017090 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017091 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
17092 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
17093 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
17094 keyword.
17095
17096table_server_id(<table>)
17097 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17098 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17099 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
17100 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
17101 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
17102 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
17103
17104table_sess_cnt(<table>)
17105 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17106 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017107 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017108 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
17109 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17110 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
17111 keyword.
17112
17113table_sess_rate(<table>)
17114 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17115 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17116 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
17117 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
17118 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17119 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
17120 keyword.
17121
17122table_trackers(<table>)
17123 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17124 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17125 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
17126 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
17127 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
17128 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
17129 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
17130 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
17131 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
17132 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
17133
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020017134ub64dec
17135 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
17136 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
17137 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
17138
17139 Example:
17140 # Decoding a JWT payload:
17141 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
17142
17143ub64enc
17144 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
17145
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017146upper
17147 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
17148 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
17149 type. The result is of type string.
17150
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020017151url_dec([<in_form>])
17152 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
17153 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
17154 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
17155 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
17156 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
17157 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020017158
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010017159url_enc([<enc_type>])
17160 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
17161 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
17162 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
17163 optional argument is here for future changes.
17164
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017165ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017166 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017167 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
17168 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
17169 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017170 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
17171 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
17172 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
17173 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017174 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017175 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
17176 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017177
17178 Example:
17179 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
17180 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
17181
17182 message Point {
17183 int32 latitude = 1;
17184 int32 longitude = 2;
17185 }
17186
17187 message PPoint {
17188 Point point = 59;
17189 }
17190
17191 message Rectangle {
17192 // One corner of the rectangle.
17193 PPoint lo = 48;
17194 // The other corner of the rectangle.
17195 PPoint hi = 49;
17196 }
17197
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017198 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
17199 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
17200 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017201
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017202 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17203 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017204 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017205 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
17206
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017207 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017208
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017209 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017210
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017211 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
17212 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17213 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017214
17215 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
17216 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
17217 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
17218
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017219 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
17220 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
17221 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017222
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017223
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010017224unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010017225 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
17226 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
17227 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
17228 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17229 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
17230 response),
17231 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17232 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
17233 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
17234 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
17235
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017236utime(<format>[,<offset>])
17237 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
17238 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
17239 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
17240 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
17241 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
17242 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
17243
17244 Example :
17245
17246 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017247 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017248 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
17249
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017250word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
17251 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
17252 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
17253 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017254 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017255 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
17256 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
17257
17258 Example :
17259 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
17260 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
17261 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
17262 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
17263 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017264 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010017265
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017266wt6([<avalanche>])
17267 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
17268 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17269 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17270 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17271 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17272 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17273 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017274 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
17275 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017276
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017277xor(<value>)
17278 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017279 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017280 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017281 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017282 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017283 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17284 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017285 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017286 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17287 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017288 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017289 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017290
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010017291xxh3([<seed>])
17292 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
17293 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
17294 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
17295 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
17296 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
17297 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
17298 considered as cryptographically secure.
17299
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010017300xxh32([<seed>])
17301 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
17302 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17303 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17304 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17305 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17306 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17307 as cryptographically secure.
17308
17309xxh64([<seed>])
17310 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
17311 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17312 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17313 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17314 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17315 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17316 as cryptographically secure.
17317
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017318
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200173197.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017320--------------------------------------------
17321
17322A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
17323not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
17324"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
17325The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
17326
17327always_false : boolean
17328 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17329 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17330
17331always_true : boolean
17332 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17333 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17334
17335avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017336 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017337 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
17338 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
17339 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
17340 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
17341 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
17342 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
17343 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
17344 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
17345 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
17346 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
17347 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
17348 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
17349 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010017350
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017351be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017352 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
17353 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
17354 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
17355 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017356 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
17357
17358be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
17359 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17360 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
17361 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
17362 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
17363 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017364 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
17365 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017366
17367 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
17368 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
17369 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017370
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017371be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
17372 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17373 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17374 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017375 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017376 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
17377 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017378
17379 Example :
17380 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
17381 backend dynamic
17382 mode http
17383 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
17384 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017385
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017386bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017387 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
17388 of the string.
17389
17390bool(<bool>) : bool
17391 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
17392 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
17393
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017394connslots([<backend>]) : integer
17395 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017396 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017397 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
17398 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050017399
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017400 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017401 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017402 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
17403
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017404 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
17405 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017406
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017407 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017408 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017409 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017410 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017411 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017412 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017413 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017414
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017415 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
17416 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017417 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017418 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017419
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017420cpu_calls : integer
17421 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
17422 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
17423 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
17424 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
17425 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
17426 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
17427
17428cpu_ns_avg : integer
17429 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17430 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17431 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17432 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17433 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17434 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17435 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
17436 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
17437 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
17438 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
17439 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
17440
17441cpu_ns_tot : integer
17442 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17443 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17444 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17445 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17446 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17447 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17448 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
17449 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
17450 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
17451 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
17452 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
17453 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
17454 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
17455
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010017456date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017457 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017458
17459 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
17460 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
17461 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017462 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
17463
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017464 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
17465 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
17466 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
17467 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
17468 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
17469
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017470 Example :
17471
17472 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
17473 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017474
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017475 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
17476 # millisecond granularity
17477 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
17478
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010017479date_us : integer
17480 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
17481 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
17482 from the same timeval structure.
17483
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017484distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
17485 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
17486 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
17487 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
17488 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017489 HAProxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017490 list of supported tokens.
17491
17492distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
17493 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
17494 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
17495 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
17496 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017497 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017498 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
17499 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
17500 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
17501 supported tokens.
17502
17503 Example :
17504 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
17505 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
17506 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
17507 # send large files to the big farm
17508 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
17509
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017510env(<name>) : string
17511 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
17512 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
17513 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
17514 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
17515 certain way.
17516
17517 Examples :
17518 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
17519 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
17520
17521 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017522 http-request deny if !{ req.cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017523
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017524fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
17525 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017526 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
17527 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017528 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
17529 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017530 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017531 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
17532 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017533
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020017534fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17535 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
17536 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
17537 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
17538
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017539fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17540 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17541 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17542 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
17543 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
17544 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
17545 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
17546 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
17547 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017548
17549 Example :
17550 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
17551 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
17552 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
17553 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
17554 frontend mail
17555 bind :25
17556 mode tcp
17557 maxconn 100
17558 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
17559 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
17560 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
17561 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017562
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010017563hostname : string
17564 Returns the system hostname.
17565
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017566int(<integer>) : signed integer
17567 Returns a signed integer.
17568
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017569ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
17570 Returns an ipv4.
17571
17572ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
17573 Returns an ipv6.
17574
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017575lat_ns_avg : integer
17576 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17577 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17578 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17579 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17580 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17581 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17582 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17583 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17584 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017585 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17586 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17587 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17588 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17589 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
17590 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017591
17592lat_ns_tot : integer
17593 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17594 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17595 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17596 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17597 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17598 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17599 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17600 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17601 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017602 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17603 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17604 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17605 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17606 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017607 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
17608 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
17609 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
17610 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
17611 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
17612 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
17613
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017614meth(<method>) : method
17615 Returns a method.
17616
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017617nbproc : integer
17618 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
17619 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
17620 and debugging purposes.
17621
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017622nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
17623 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
17624 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
17625 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017626 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
17627 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
17628 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017629
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040017630prio_class : integer
17631 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
17632 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
17633 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
17634
17635prio_offset : integer
17636 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
17637 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
17638 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
17639 set-priority-offset".
17640
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017641proc : integer
17642 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
17643 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
17644 debugging purposes.
17645
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017646queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017647 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
17648 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
17649 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017650 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
17651 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
17652 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
17653 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
17654 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
17655
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010017656rand([<range>]) : integer
17657 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
17658 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
17659 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
17660 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
17661 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
17662
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017663srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17664 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17665 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
17666 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
17667 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
17668 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017669 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
17670 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
17671
17672srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17673 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17674 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
17675 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17676 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
17677 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
17678 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
17679 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
17680
17681 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
17682 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017683
17684srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
17685 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
17686 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
17687 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017688 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017689 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
17690 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
17691 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
17692
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020017693srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17694 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
17695 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17696 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
17697 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
17698 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
17699 fetch methods.
17700
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017701srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17702 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17703 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017704 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017705 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
17706 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017707 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017708 overloading servers).
17709
17710 Example :
17711 # Redirect to a separate back
17712 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
17713 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
17714 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
17715
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017716srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017717 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
17718 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
17719 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
17720
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017721srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017722 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
17723 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17724 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
17725
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017726srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017727 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
17728 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17729 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
17730
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017731stopping : boolean
17732 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
17733 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
17734 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
17735
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017736str(<string>) : string
17737 Returns a string.
17738
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017739table_avl([<table>]) : integer
17740 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
17741 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
17742
17743table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17744 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
17745 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
17746 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
17747
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010017748thread : integer
17749 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
17750 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
17751 and debugging purposes.
17752
Alexandar Lazica429ad32021-06-01 00:27:01 +020017753uuid([<version>]) : string
17754 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
17755 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
17756 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
17757
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017758var(<var-name>) : undefined
17759 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017760 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
17761 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017762 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017763 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17764 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017765 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017766 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17767 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017768 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017769 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017770
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200177717.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017772----------------------------------
17773
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017774The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017775closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
17776methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
17777sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
17778TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017779the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
17780counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020017781"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
17782used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
17783can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
17784Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
17785table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
17786tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
17787currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017788
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017789bc_dst : ip
17790 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
17791 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
17792 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
17793 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17794
17795bc_dst_port : integer
17796 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017797 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected to.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017798
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010017799bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010017800 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17801 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17802 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
17803
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017804bc_src : ip
17805 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017806 the server address HAProxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017807 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
17808 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17809
17810bc_src_port : integer
17811 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017812 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected from.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017813
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017814be_id : integer
17815 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017816 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17817 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017818
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017819be_name : string
17820 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017821 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17822 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017823
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010017824be_server_timeout : integer
17825 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
17826 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17827 also the "cur_server_timeout".
17828
17829be_tunnel_timeout : integer
17830 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
17831 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17832 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
17833
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010017834cur_server_timeout : integer
17835 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17836 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
17837 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
17838
17839cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
17840 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17841 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
17842 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
17843
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017844dst : ip
17845 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
17846 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
17847 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
17848 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017849 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
17850 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
17851 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
17852 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
17853 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
17854 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017855
17856dst_conn : integer
17857 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17858 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
17859 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
17860 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
17861 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
17862 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
17863 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
17864 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017865
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017866dst_is_local : boolean
17867 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
17868 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
17869 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
17870 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017871 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017872 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
17873 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
17874 it only once per connection.
17875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017876dst_port : integer
17877 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
17878 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
17879 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
17880 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
17881 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
17882 an HTTP header.
17883
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017884fc_fackets : integer
17885 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
17886 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17887 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17888 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17889
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020017890fc_http_major : integer
17891 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17892 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17893 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
17894
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017895fc_lost : integer
17896 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
17897 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17898 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17899 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17900
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020017901fc_pp_authority : string
17902 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17903 if any.
17904
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010017905fc_pp_unique_id : string
17906 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17907 if any.
17908
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010017909fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
17910 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
17911 header.
17912
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017913fc_reordering : integer
17914 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
17915 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17916 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17917 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17918
17919fc_retrans : integer
17920 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
17921 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17922 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17923 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17924
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020017925fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
17926 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
17927 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
17928 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
17929 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17930 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17931 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17932
17933fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
17934 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
17935 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
17936 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
17937 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17938 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17939 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17940
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017941fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017942 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17943 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17944 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17945 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17946
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017947
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017948fc_unacked : integer
17949 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17950 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17951 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17952 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017953
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020017954fe_defbe : string
17955 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
17956 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
17957
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017958fe_id : integer
17959 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010017960 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017961 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17962
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017963fe_name : string
17964 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
17965 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
17966 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17967
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010017968fe_client_timeout : integer
17969 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
17970 current frontend.
17971
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017972sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017973sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17974sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17975sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017976 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
17977 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17978 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
17979
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017980sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017981sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17982sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17983sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017984 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
17985 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17986 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
17987
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017988sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017989sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17990sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17991sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017992 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17993 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017994 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17995 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17996 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017997
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017998 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017999 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
18000 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018001 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
18002 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
18003 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018004 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18005 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18006
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018007sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18008sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18009sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18010sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18011 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
18012 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
18013 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
18014 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
18015 when a first ACL was verified.
18016
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018017sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018018sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18019sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18020sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018021 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018022 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
18023
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018024sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018025sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
18026sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
18027sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018028 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
18029 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
18030 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
18031
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018032sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018033sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18034sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18035sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018036 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
18037 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
18038 See also src_conn_rate.
18039
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018040sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018041sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18042sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18043sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018044 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018045 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018046
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018047sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18048sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18049sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18050sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18051 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18052 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18053
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018054sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18055sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18056sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18057sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18058 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18059 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
18060
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018061sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018062sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
18063sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
18064sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018065 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
18066 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
18067 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018068 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18069 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18070 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018071
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018072sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18073sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18074sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18075sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18076 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18077 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
18078 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18079 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18080 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18081 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18082
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018083sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018084sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18085sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18086sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018087 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018088 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
18089 See also src_http_err_cnt.
18090
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018091sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018092sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18093sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18094sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018095 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
18096 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18097 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
18098 src_http_err_rate.
18099
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018100sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18101sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18102sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18103sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18104 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
18105 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
18106 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
18107
18108sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18109sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18110sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18111sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18112 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
18113 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
18114 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
18115 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
18116
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018117sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018118sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18119sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18120sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018121 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018122 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18123 src_http_req_cnt.
18124
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018125sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018126sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18127sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18128sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018129 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
18130 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
18131 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18132 src_http_req_rate.
18133
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018134sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018135sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18136sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18137sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018138 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018139 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18140 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18141 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18142 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018143
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018144 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018145 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
18146 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018147 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18148
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018149sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18150sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18151sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18152sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18153 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
18154 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18155 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18156 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18157 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
18158
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018159sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018160sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18161sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18162sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018163 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
18164 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18165 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018166
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018167sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018168sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18169sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18170sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018171 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
18172 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18173 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018174
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018175sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018176sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18177sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18178sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018179 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018180 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
18181 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
18182 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018183 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018184 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
18185
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018186sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018187sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18188sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18189sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018190 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
18191 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18192 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
18193 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
18194 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018195 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018196
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018197sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018198sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18199sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18200sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020018201 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
18202 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
18203 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
18204
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018205sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018206sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18207sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18208sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018209 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
18210 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018211 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018212 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
18213 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018214 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
18215 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
18216 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018217
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018218so_id : integer
18219 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
18220 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
18221 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018222
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010018223so_name : string
18224 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
18225 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
18226 strings instead of integers.
18227
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018228src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018229 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018230 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
18231 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
18232 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018233 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
18234 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
18235 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010018236 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
18237 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
18238 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
18239 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
18240 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
18241 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
18242 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018243
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018244 Example:
18245 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
18246 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
18247
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018248src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18249 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
18250 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
18251 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018252 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018253
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018254src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18255 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
18256 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018257 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018258 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018259
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018260src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18261 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18262 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18263 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18264 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18265 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18266 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018267
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018268 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018269 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
18270 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
18271 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
18272 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018273 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018274 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18275 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18276
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018277src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18278 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18279 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18280 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18281 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18282 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18283 was verified.
18284
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018285src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018286 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018287 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018288 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018289 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018290
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018291src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018292 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018293 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18294 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018295 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018296
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018297src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18298 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
18299 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18300 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018301 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018302
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018303src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018304 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018305 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018306 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018307 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018308
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018309src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18310 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18311 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18312 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18313 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
18314
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018315src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18316 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18317 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18318 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18319 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
18320
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018321src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018322 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018323 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018324 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18325 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018326 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18327 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18328 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018329
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018330src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18331 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18332 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18333 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18334 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18335 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18336 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18337 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18338
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018339src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018340 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018341 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018342 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018343 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018344 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018345
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018346src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18347 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
18348 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18349 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18350 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018351 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018352
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018353src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18354 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
18355 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050018356 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018357 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
18358 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18359
18360src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18361 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
18362 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18363 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
18364 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
18365 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
18366 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
18367
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018368src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018369 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018370 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18371 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018372 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018373
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018374src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18375 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
18376 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18377 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018378 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018379 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018380
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018381src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18382 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18383 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18384 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018385 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018386 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18387 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018388
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018389 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018390 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018391 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018392 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018393
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018394src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18395 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18396 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18397 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
18398 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18399 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18400 connection when a first ACL was verified.
18401
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018402src_is_local : boolean
18403 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
18404 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
18405 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
18406 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018407 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018408 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
18409 once per connection.
18410
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018411src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018412 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
18413 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
18414 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
18415 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
18416 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018417
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018418src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018419 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
18420 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18421 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
18422 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
18423 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018424
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018425src_port : integer
18426 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
18427 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
18428 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
18429 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010018430
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018431src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018432 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018433 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18434 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
18435 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018436 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018437
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018438src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18439 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
18440 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18441 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18442 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018443 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018444
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018445src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18446 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
18447 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
18448 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
18449 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
18450 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
18451 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
18452 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
18453 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018454
18455 Example :
18456 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
18457 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
18458 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
18459 listen ssh
18460 bind :22
18461 mode tcp
18462 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018463 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018464 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018465 server local 127.0.0.1:22
18466
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018467srv_id : integer
18468 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
18469 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018470 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020018471
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018472srv_name : string
18473 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
18474 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018475 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018476
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200184777.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018478----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020018479
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018480The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018481closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
18482when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
18483usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018484future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018485
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001848651d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
18487 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
18488 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
18489 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
18490 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
18491 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
18492
18493 Example :
18494 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
18495 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
18496 # the request.
18497 frontend http-in
18498 bind *:8081
18499 default_backend servers
18500 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
18501 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
18502
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018503ssl_bc : boolean
18504 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18505 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Mariam John3d379952023-05-22 13:11:13 -050018506 to a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018507 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018508
18509ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
18510 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018511 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18512 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018513
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018514ssl_bc_alpn : string
18515 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
18516 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018517 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018518 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18519 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18520 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
18521 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
18522 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018523 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
18524 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018525
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018526ssl_bc_cipher : string
18527 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018528 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18529 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018530
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018531ssl_bc_client_random : binary
18532 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18533 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18534 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018535 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018536
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018537ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
18538 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18539 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018540 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18541 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018542
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018543ssl_bc_npn : string
18544 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
18545 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018546 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018547 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
18548 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
18549 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
18550 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018551 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
18552 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018553
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018554ssl_bc_protocol : string
18555 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018556 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18557 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018558
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018559ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018560 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018561 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018562 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
18563 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018564
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018565ssl_bc_server_random : binary
18566 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18567 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18568 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018569 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018570
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018571ssl_bc_session_id : binary
18572 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
18573 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018574 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18575 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018576
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018577ssl_bc_session_key : binary
18578 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
18579 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18580 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018581 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018582
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018583ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
18584 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018585 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18586 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018587
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018588ssl_c_ca_err : integer
18589 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18590 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
18591 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
18592 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
18593 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018594
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018595ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
18596 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18597 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
18598 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
18599 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018600
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018601ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018602 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
18603 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18604 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018605 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018606 does not support resumed sessions.
18607
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018608ssl_c_der : binary
18609 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
18610 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18611 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18612
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018613ssl_c_err : integer
18614 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18615 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
18616 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
18617 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
18618 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018619
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018620ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018621 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18622 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18623 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18624 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18625 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18626 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18627 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18628 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018629 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18630 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18631 LDAP v3.
18632 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18633 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018635ssl_c_key_alg : string
18636 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18637 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18638 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018639
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018640ssl_c_notafter : string
18641 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
18642 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18643 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018645ssl_c_notbefore : string
18646 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
18647 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18648 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018649
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018650ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018651 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18652 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18653 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18654 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18655 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18656 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18657 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18658 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018659 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18660 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18661 LDAP v3.
18662 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18663 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018665ssl_c_serial : binary
18666 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
18667 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18668 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018670ssl_c_sha1 : binary
18671 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
18672 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
18673 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018674 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
18675 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
18676
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018677 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018678 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018679
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018680ssl_c_sig_alg : string
18681 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18682 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18683 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018684
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018685ssl_c_used : boolean
18686 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
18687 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018688
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018689ssl_c_verify : integer
18690 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
18691 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
18692 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
18693 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018694
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018695ssl_c_version : integer
18696 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
18697 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018698
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010018699ssl_f_der : binary
18700 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
18701 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18702 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18703
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018704ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018705 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18706 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18707 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18708 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018709 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018710 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18711 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18712 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018713 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18714 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18715 LDAP v3.
18716 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18717 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018718
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018719ssl_f_key_alg : string
18720 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18721 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
18722 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018723
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018724ssl_f_notafter : string
18725 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18726 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18727 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018728
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018729ssl_f_notbefore : string
18730 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18731 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18732 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018733
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018734ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018735 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18736 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18737 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18738 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18739 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18740 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18741 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18742 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018743 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18744 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18745 LDAP v3.
18746 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18747 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018748
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018749ssl_f_serial : binary
18750 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18751 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18752 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018753
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020018754ssl_f_sha1 : binary
18755 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
18756 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18757 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18758
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018759ssl_f_sig_alg : string
18760 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18761 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18762 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018763
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018764ssl_f_version : integer
18765 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18766 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18767
18768ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018769 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18770 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
18771 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
18772
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018773 Example :
18774 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
18775 listen http-https
18776 bind :80
18777 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
18778 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
18779
18780ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
18781 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
18782 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18783
18784ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018785 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018786 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018787 HAProxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018788 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18789 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18790 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
18791 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
18792 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
18793 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
18794
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018795ssl_fc_cipher : string
18796 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
18797 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020018798
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018799ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
18800 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
18801 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018802 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018803
18804ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
18805 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
18806 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018807 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018808
18809ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
18810 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
18811 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
18812 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018813 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020018814 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018815
18816ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
18817 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
18818 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018819 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018820
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018821ssl_fc_client_random : binary
18822 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18823 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18824 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18825
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018826ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
18827 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18828 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18829 transport layer.
18830 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18831 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18832 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18833 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18834
18835ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18836 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18837 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18838 transport layer.
18839 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18840 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18841 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18842 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18843
18844ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
18845 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18846 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18847 transport layer.
18848 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18849 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18850 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18851 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18852
18853ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
18854 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18855 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18856 transport layer.
18857 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18858 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18859 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18860 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18861
18862ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
18863 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18864 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18865 transport layer.
18866 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18867 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18868 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18869 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018871ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018872 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
18873 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010018874 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
18875 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
18876 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
18877 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018878
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020018879ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
18880 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
18881 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
18882 wait until the handshake happened.
18883
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018884ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
18885 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018886 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
18887 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018888 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018889 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018890
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020018891ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018892 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010018893 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
18894 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018895
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018896ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018897 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018898 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by HAProxy. The result
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018899 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
18900 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
18901 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
18902 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
18903 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
18904 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020018905
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018906ssl_fc_protocol : string
18907 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
18908 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018909
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018910ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018911 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018912 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletc5de4192021-11-09 14:23:36 +010018913 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_fc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018914
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018915ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18916 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18917 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18918 transport layer.
18919 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18920 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18921 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18922 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18923
18924ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
18925 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18926 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18927 transport layer.
18928 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18929 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18930 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18931 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18932
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018933ssl_fc_server_random : binary
18934 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18935 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18936 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18937
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018938ssl_fc_session_id : binary
18939 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
18940 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
18941 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
18942 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018943
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018944ssl_fc_session_key : binary
18945 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
18946 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18947 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
18948 BoringSSL.
18949
18950
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018951ssl_fc_sni : string
18952 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
18953 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018954 deciphered by HAProxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018955 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
18956 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
18957
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020018958 This fetch is different from "req.ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018959 connection being deciphered by HAProxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018960 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018961 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020018962 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018963
Willy Tarreau000d4002022-11-25 10:12:12 +010018964 CAUTION! Except under very specific conditions, it is normally not correct to
18965 use this field as a substitute for the HTTP "Host" header field. For example,
18966 when forwarding an HTTPS connection to a server, the SNI field must be set
18967 from the HTTP Host header field using "req.hdr(host)" and not from the front
18968 SNI value. The reason is that SNI is solely used to select the certificate
18969 the server side will present, and that clients are then allowed to send
18970 requests with different Host values as long as they match the names in the
18971 certificate. As such, "ssl_fc_sni" should normally not be used as an argument
18972 to the "sni" server keyword, unless the backend works in TCP mode.
18973
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018974 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018975 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
18976 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020018977
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018978ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
18979 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
18980 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018981
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018982ssl_s_der : binary
18983 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
18984 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18985 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18986
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018987ssl_s_chain_der : binary
18988 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
18989 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18990 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018991 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018992 does not support resumed sessions.
18993
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018994ssl_s_key_alg : string
18995 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18996 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
18997 SSL/TLS transport layer.
18998
18999ssl_s_notafter : string
19000 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
19001 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19002 transport layer.
19003
19004ssl_s_notbefore : string
19005 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
19006 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19007 transport layer.
19008
19009ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
19010 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19011 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
19012 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19013 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19014 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19015 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020019016 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19017 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019018 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19019 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19020 LDAP v3.
19021 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19022 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
19023
19024ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
19025 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19026 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
19027 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19028 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19029 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19030 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020019031 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19032 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019033 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19034 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19035 LDAP v3.
19036 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19037 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
19038
19039ssl_s_serial : binary
19040 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
19041 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19042 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19043
19044ssl_s_sha1 : binary
19045 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
19046 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
19047 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
19048
19049ssl_s_sig_alg : string
19050 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
19051 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
19052 layer.
19053
19054ssl_s_version : integer
19055 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
19056 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019057
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200190587.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019059------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019060
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019061Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
19062sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
19063only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
19064For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
19065be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
19066can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
19067sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
19068for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
19069content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019070
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010019071Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
19072 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019073 HTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010019074 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
19075 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
19076 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
19077 sample expression). So be careful.
19078
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019079payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019080 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019081 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
19082 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019084payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
19085 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019086 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019087 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019088
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019089req.len : integer
19090req_len : integer (deprecated)
19091 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19092 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19093 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19094 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19095 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019096 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019097 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
19098 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019099
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019100req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19101 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019102 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
19103 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
19104 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
19105 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019106
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019107 ACL derivatives :
19108 req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019109
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019110req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19111 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19112 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19113 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
19114 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019115
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019116 ACL derivatives :
19117 req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019118
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019119 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019120
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019121req.proto_http : boolean
19122req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
19123 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
19124 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
19125 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
19126 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
19127 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
19128 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
19129 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019130
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019131 Example:
19132 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
19133 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19134 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019135 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019136
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019137req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
19138rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19139 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
19140 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
19141 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
19142 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
19143 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
19144 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
19145 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019146
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019147 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
19148 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
19149 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
19150 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
19151 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
19152 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019153
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019154 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019155 req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019156
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019157 Example :
19158 listen tse-farm
19159 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
19160 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
19161 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19162 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
19163 # apply RDP cookie persistence
19164 persist rdp-cookie
19165 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
19166 # This is only useful makes sense if
19167 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
19168 stick-table type string size 204800
19169 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
19170 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
19171 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019172
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019173 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019174 "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019175
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019176req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
19177rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
19178 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
19179 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
19180 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
19181 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019182
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019183 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019184 req.rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019185
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019186req.ssl_alpn : string
19187 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
19188 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
19189 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
19190 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
19191 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
19192 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019193 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019194
19195 Examples :
19196 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19197 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019198 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019199 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019200 default_backend bk_default
19201
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019202req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
19203 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
19204 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020019205 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
19206 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
19207 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
19208 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
19209 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019210
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019211req.ssl_hello_type : integer
19212req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19213 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19214 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
19215 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19216 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19217 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
19218 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19219 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019220
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019221req.ssl_sni : string
19222req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
19223 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
19224 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
19225 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
19226 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19227 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020019228 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
19229 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
19230 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
19231 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
19232 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
19233 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
19234 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
19235 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
19236 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019237
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019238 ACL derivatives :
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019239 req.ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019240
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019241 Examples :
19242 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19243 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019244 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019245 use_backend bk_allow if { req.ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019246 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019247
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053019248req.ssl_st_ext : integer
19249 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
19250 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
19251 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
19252 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
19253 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
19254 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
19255 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
19256 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
19257 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
19258
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019259req.ssl_ver : integer
19260req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
19261 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
19262 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
19263 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
19264 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
19265 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19266 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
19267 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019268 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019269 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019270
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019271 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019272 req.ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019273
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019274res.len : integer
19275 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19276 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19277 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19278 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19279 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019280 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019281 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019282 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019283
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019284res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19285 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019286 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019287 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019288 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019289 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019290
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019291res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19292 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19293 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19294 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019295 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
19296 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019297
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019298 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019299
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020019300res.ssl_hello_type : integer
19301rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19302 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19303 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
19304 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19305 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19306 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
19307 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19308 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
19309
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019310wait_end : boolean
19311 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
19312 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019313 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019314 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
19315 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019316 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019317 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
19318 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019319
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019320 Examples :
19321 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
19322 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
19323 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019325 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
19326 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19327 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
19328 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
19329 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
19330 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
19331 tcp-request content reject
19332
19333
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200193347.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019335--------------------------------------
19336
19337It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
19338This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
19339data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
19340its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
19341HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
19342content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
19343to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
19344more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
19345response are indexed.
19346
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010019347Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
19348 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
19349 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
19350 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
19351 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
19352 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
19353 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
19354
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019355base : string
19356 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19357 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
19358 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
19359 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
19360 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
19361 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
19362 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
19363 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
19364
19365 ACL derivatives :
19366 base : exact string match
19367 base_beg : prefix match
19368 base_dir : subdir match
19369 base_dom : domain match
19370 base_end : suffix match
19371 base_len : length match
19372 base_reg : regex match
19373 base_sub : substring match
19374
19375base32 : integer
19376 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
19377 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
19378 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020019379 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
19380 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
19381 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019382
19383base32+src : binary
19384 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
19385 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
19386 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
19387 per-URL counters.
19388
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010019389baseq : string
19390 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19391 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
19392 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
19393 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
19394
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019395capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
19396 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
19397 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19398 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
19399
19400capture.req.method : string
19401 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
19402 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
19403 because it's allocated.
19404
19405capture.req.uri : string
19406 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
19407 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
19408 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
19409 allocated.
19410
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019411capture.req.ver : string
19412 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19413 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
19414 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
19415
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019416capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
19417 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
19418 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19419 The first entry is an index of 0.
19420 See also: "capture response header"
19421
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019422capture.res.ver : string
19423 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19424 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
19425 persistent flag.
19426
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019427req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019428 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
19429 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
19430 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019431
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020019432req.body_param([<name>) : string
19433 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
19434 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
19435 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
19436 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
19437 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
19438 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
19439 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
19440 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
19441 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
19442 given.
19443
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019444req.body_len : integer
19445 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
19446 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019447 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
19448 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019449
19450req.body_size : integer
19451 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019452 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19453 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019454
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019455req.cook([<name>]) : string
19456cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19457 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19458 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
19459 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
19460 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
19461 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
19462 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
19463 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
19464 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
19465
19466 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019467 req.cook([<name>]) : exact string match
19468 req.cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
19469 req.cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
19470 req.cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
19471 req.cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
19472 req.cook_len([<name>]) : length match
19473 req.cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
19474 req.cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019475
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019476req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19477cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19478 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19479 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019480
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019481req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19482cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19483 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19484 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
19485 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
19486 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019488cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19489 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19490 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
19491 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
19492 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019493 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019494 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
19495 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
19496 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
19497 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019498
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019499hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19500 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
19501 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
19502 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
19503 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019504 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019505
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019506req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019507 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
19508 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
19509 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
19510 with headers such as User-Agent.
19511
19512 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19513 found.
19514
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019515 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19516 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19517 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019518 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019519
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019520req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19521 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19522 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019523 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
19524 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019526req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019527 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
19528 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
19529 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
19530 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
19531 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
19532 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
19533 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
19534
19535 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19536 found.
19537
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019538 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19539 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19540 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019541 with -1 being the last one.
19542
19543 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
19544 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019545
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019546 ACL derivatives :
19547 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19548 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19549 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19550 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19551 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19552 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19553 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19554 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19555
19556req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19557hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
19558 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19559 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019560 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
19561 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
19562 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
19563
19564 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
19565 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
19566 which contain more than one of certain headers.
19567
19568 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019569
19570req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19571hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
19572 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
19573 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
19574 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010019575 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
19576 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
19577 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
19578 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
19579 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019580
19581 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19582
19583 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019584
19585req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19586hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
19587 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
19588 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
19589 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019590
19591 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19592
19593 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019594
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019595req.hdrs : string
19596 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
19597 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19598 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
19599 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19600
19601req.hdrs_bin : binary
19602 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19603 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
19604 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
19605 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
19606 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
19607 names and values (length of 0 for both).
19608
19609 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019610
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019611 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19612 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019613
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019614http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
19615 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
19616 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
19617 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19618 basic auth is supported.
19619
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019620http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
19621 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
19622 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
19623 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
19624 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019625 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19626 basic auth is supported.
19627
19628 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019629 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
19630 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
19631 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
19632 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019633
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019634http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019635 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
19636 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19637 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019638
19639http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019640 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
19641 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19642 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019643
19644http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019645 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
19646 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
19647 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019648
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019649http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019650 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
19651 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019652 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
19653 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019654
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019655method : integer + string
19656 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
19657 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
19658 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
19659 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
19660 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
19661 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
19662 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019663
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019664 ACL derivatives :
19665 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019666
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019667 Example :
19668 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
19669 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
19670 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019672path : string
19673 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
19674 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
19675 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
19676 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
19677 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019678 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019679 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019680
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019681 ACL derivatives :
19682 path : exact string match
19683 path_beg : prefix match
19684 path_dir : subdir match
19685 path_dom : domain match
19686 path_end : suffix match
19687 path_len : length match
19688 path_reg : regex match
19689 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019690
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020019691pathq : string
19692 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
19693 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
19694 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
19695 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
19696 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
19697 result in both cases.
19698
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019699query : string
19700 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
19701 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
19702 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
19703 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010019704 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019705 which stops before the question mark.
19706
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019707req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19708 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19709 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19710 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
19711 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19712
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019713req.ver : string
19714req_ver : string (deprecated)
19715 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
19716 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
19717 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019718
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019719 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019720 req.ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019721
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019722res.body : binary
19723 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
19724 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019725 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19726
19727 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019728
19729res.body_len : integer
19730 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
19731 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019732 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19733
19734 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019735
19736res.body_size : integer
19737 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
19738 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19739 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
19740 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019741 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19742
19743 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019744
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010019745res.cache_hit : boolean
19746 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
19747 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
19748
19749res.cache_name : string
19750 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
19751 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
19752 empty string.
19753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019754res.comp : boolean
19755 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
19756 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
19757 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019758
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019759res.comp_algo : string
19760 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
19761 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
19762 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019763
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019764res.cook([<name>]) : string
19765scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19766 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19767 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019768 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19769
19770 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019771
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019772 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019773 res.scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019774
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019775res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19776scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19777 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19778 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019779 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
19780
19781 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019782
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019783res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19784scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19785 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19786 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019787 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19788
19789 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019790
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019791res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019792 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19793 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19794
19795 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
19796 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
19797
19798 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
19799
19800 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019802res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019803 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19804 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19805
19806 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
19807 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
19808
19809 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019810
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019811res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19812shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019813 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19814 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19815
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019816 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019817 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
19818
19819 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019821 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019822 res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19823 res.hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19824 res.hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19825 res.hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19826 res.hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19827 res.hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19828 res.hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19829 res.hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019830
19831res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19832shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019833 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19834 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19835
19836 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019837 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019838
19839 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019840
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019841res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19842shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019843 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
19844 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19845
19846 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19847
19848 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019849
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019850res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19851 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19852 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19853 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019854 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19855
19856 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019857
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019858res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19859shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019860 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
19861 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19862
19863 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19864
19865 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019866
19867res.hdrs : string
19868 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
19869 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19870 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019871 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19872
19873 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019874
19875res.hdrs_bin : binary
19876 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19877 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
19878 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
19879 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
19880 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
19881 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
19882 (length of 0 for both).
19883
19884 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
19885
19886 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19887 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019888
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019889res.ver : string
19890resp_ver : string (deprecated)
19891 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019892 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
19893
19894 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019895
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019896 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019897 resp.ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019898
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019899set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19900 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19901 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019902 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019903 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019904
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019905 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
19906 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019907
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019908status : integer
19909 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
19910 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019911 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
19912
19913 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019914
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020019915unique-id : string
19916 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
19917 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
19918 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
19919 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
19920 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
19921 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
19922
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019923url : string
19924 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
19925 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
19926 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
19927 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
19928 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
19929 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
19930 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019931
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019932 ACL derivatives :
19933 url : exact string match
19934 url_beg : prefix match
19935 url_dir : subdir match
19936 url_dom : domain match
19937 url_end : suffix match
19938 url_len : length match
19939 url_reg : regex match
19940 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019941
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019942url_ip : ip
19943 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
19944 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
19945 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
19946 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
19947 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
19948 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19949 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019950
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019951url_port : integer
19952 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
19953 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
19954 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19955 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019956
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019957urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
19958url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019959 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
19960 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019961 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
19962 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
19963 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
19964 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019965 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
19966 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019967 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
19968 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019969
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019970 ACL derivatives :
19971 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
19972 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
19973 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
19974 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
19975 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
19976 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
19977 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
19978 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019979
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019980
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019981 Example :
19982 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
19983 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
19984 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
19985 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019986
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019987urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019988 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
19989 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
19990 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020019991
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020019992url32 : integer
19993 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
19994 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
19995 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
19996 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
19997 is an unsigned integer.
19998
19999url32+src : binary
20000 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
20001 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
20002 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
20003
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020020004
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200200057.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020006---------------------------------------
20007
20008This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
20009used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
20010purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
20011There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
20012or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
20013any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
20014for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
20015
20016internal.htx.data : integer
20017 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
20018 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20019
20020internal.htx.free : integer
20021 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
20022 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20023
20024internal.htx.free_data : integer
20025 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
20026 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20027
20028internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010020029 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
20030 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
20031 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020032
20033internal.htx.nbblks : integer
20034 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
20035 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20036
20037internal.htx.size : integer
20038 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
20039 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20040
20041internal.htx.used : integer
20042 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
20043 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20044 direction.
20045
20046internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
20047 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20048 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
20049 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
20050 of the special value :
20051 * head : The oldest inserted block
20052 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020053 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020054
20055internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
20056 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20057 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
20058 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
20059 integer or one of the special value :
20060 * head : The oldest inserted block
20061 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020062 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020063
20064internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
20065 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20066 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
20067 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20068 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20069
20070 * head : The oldest inserted block
20071 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020072 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020073
20074internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
20075 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
20076 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
20077 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20078 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20079
20080 * head : The oldest inserted block
20081 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020082 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020083
20084internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
20085 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
20086 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
20087 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20088 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20089
20090 * head : The oldest inserted block
20091 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020092 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020093
20094internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
20095 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
20096 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
20097 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20098 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20099
20100 * head : The oldest inserted block
20101 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020102 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020103
20104internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
20105 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
20106 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
20107 it returns false.
20108
20109
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200201107.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020111---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020112
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020113Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
20114every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020020115order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020116
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020117ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020118---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
20119FALSE always_false never match
20120HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
20121HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
20122HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010020123HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020124HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
20125HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
20126HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
20127HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
20128LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
20129METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
20130METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
20131METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
20132METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
20133METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
20134METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
20135METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
20136METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
20137RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
20138REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
20139TRUE always_true always match
20140WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
20141---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020142
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010020143
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200201448. Logging
20145----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010020146
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020147One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
20148provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
20149very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
20150provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
20151state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020152to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020153headers.
20154
20155In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
20156about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
20157send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
20158
20159 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
20160 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
20161 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
20162 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
20163 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020164 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060020165 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020166
20167The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
20168allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
20169as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
20170while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
20171real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
20172delay.
20173
20174
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200201758.1. Log levels
20176---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020177
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020178TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020179source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020180HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
20181in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
20182track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
20183syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
20184about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020185
20186
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200201878.2. Log formats
20188----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020189
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020190HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020191and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
20192slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
20193options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020194
20195 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
20196 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
20197 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
20198 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
20199 extents.
20200
20201 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
20202 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
20203 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
20204 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
20205 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
20206
20207 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
20208 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
20209 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
20210 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
20211 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
20212
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020020213 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
20214 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
20215 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
20216 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
20217
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020218 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
20219
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020220Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
20221specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
20222field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
20223servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
20224always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
20225identifier.
20226
20227Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
20228 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
20229 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
20230 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
20231 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
20232
20233
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200202348.2.1. Default log format
20235-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020236
20237This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
20238as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
20239format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
20240
20241 Example :
20242 listen www
20243 mode http
20244 log global
20245 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20246
20247 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
20248 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
20249 (www/HTTP)
20250
20251 Field Format Extract from the example above
20252 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
20253 2 'Connect from' Connect from
20254 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
20255 4 'to' to
20256 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
20257 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
20258
20259Detailed fields description :
20260 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
20261 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
20262 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
20263 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
20264 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20265 and processed the connection.
20266 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
20267
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020268In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
20269"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
20270connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
20271
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020272It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
20273will eventually disappear.
20274
20275
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200202768.2.2. TCP log format
20277---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020278
20279The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
20280is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
20281information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
20282counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
20283emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
20284environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
20285the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
20286sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020287specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
20288not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
20289fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
20290marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020291
20292 Example :
20293 frontend fnt
20294 mode tcp
20295 option tcplog
20296 log global
20297 default_backend bck
20298
20299 backend bck
20300 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20301
20302 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
20303 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
20304 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
20305
20306 Field Format Extract from the example above
20307 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
20308 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
20309 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
20310 4 frontend_name fnt
20311 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
20312 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
20313 7 bytes_read* 212
20314 8 termination_state --
20315 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
20316 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20317
20318Detailed fields description :
20319 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020320 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020321 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20322 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020323 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020324 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020325 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020326
20327 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020328 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20329 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20330 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020331
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020332 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by HAProxy
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020333 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
20334 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020335 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
20336 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
20337 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
20338 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020339
20340 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20341 and processed the connection.
20342
20343 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20344 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20345 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
20346 applications.
20347
20348 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20349 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20350 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20351 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
20352 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
20353
20354 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20355 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
20356 See "Timers" below for more details.
20357
20358 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20359 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
20360 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
20361 "Timers" below for more details.
20362
20363 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020364 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020365 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
20366 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
20367 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
20368 details.
20369
20370 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
20371 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
20372 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
20373 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
20374 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
20375
20376 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20377 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20378 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
20379 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
20380 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
20381 for more details.
20382
20383 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020384 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020385 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
20386 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
20387 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020388 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020389
20390 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20391 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20392 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20393 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20394 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20395 caused by a denial of service attack.
20396
20397 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20398 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20399 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20400 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20401 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20402 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20403 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20404 denial of service attack.
20405
20406 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20407 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20408 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20409 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20410 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20411 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20412 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20413 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
20414 be processed than on other servers.
20415
20416 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20417 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20418 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20419 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020420 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020421 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20422 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20423 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20424 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20425 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20426 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20427 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20428 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20429
20430 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20431 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20432 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20433 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20434 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20435 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020436 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020437 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20438
20439 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20440 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20441 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20442 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20443 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20444 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020445 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020446 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20447 occurs.
20448
20449
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200204508.2.3. HTTP log format
20451----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020452
20453The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
20454is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
20455the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
20456are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
20457emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
20458generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
20459"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
20460which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020461frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
20462is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020463
20464Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
20465slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
20466with a star ('*') after the field name below.
20467
20468 Example :
20469 frontend http-in
20470 mode http
20471 option httplog
20472 log global
20473 default_backend bck
20474
20475 backend static
20476 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20477
20478 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
20479 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
20480 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020481 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020482
20483 Field Format Extract from the example above
20484 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
20485 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020486 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020487 4 frontend_name http-in
20488 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020489 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020490 7 status_code 200
20491 8 bytes_read* 2750
20492 9 captured_request_cookie -
20493 10 captured_response_cookie -
20494 11 termination_state ----
20495 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
20496 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20497 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
20498 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
20499 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020500
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020501Detailed fields description :
20502 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020503 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020504 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20505 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020506 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020507 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020508 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020509
20510 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020511 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20512 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20513 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020514
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020515 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020516 was received by HAProxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020517
20518 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20519 and processed the connection.
20520
20521 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20522 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20523 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
20524
20525 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20526 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20527 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20528 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
20529 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
20530 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
20531
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020532 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
20533 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
20534 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020535 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020536 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
20537 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020538 HAProxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020539 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020540
20541 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20542 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020543 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020544
20545 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20546 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020547 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
20548 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020549
20550 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
20551 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
20552 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
20553 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
20554 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020555 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
20556 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020557
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020558 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in HAProxy, which is the total
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020559 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
20560 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
20561 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
20562 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
20563 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
20564 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020565 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020566
20567 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020568 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by HAProxy when
20569 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020570
20571 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
20572 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020573 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020574 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
20575 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
20576 overflowing.
20577
20578 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
20579 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
20580 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
20581 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
20582 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
20583 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
20584 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
20585 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20586
20587 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
20588 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
20589 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
20590 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
20591 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
20592 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
20593 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
20594 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20595
20596 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20597 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20598 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
20599 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
20600 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
20601 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
20602 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
20603
20604 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020605 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020606 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
20607 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
20608 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020609 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020610 system.
20611
20612 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20613 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20614 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20615 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20616 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20617 caused by a denial of service attack.
20618
20619 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20620 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20621 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20622 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20623 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20624 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20625 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20626 denial of service attack.
20627
20628 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20629 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20630 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20631 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20632 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20633 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20634 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20635 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
20636 processed than on other servers.
20637
20638 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20639 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20640 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20641 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020642 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020643 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20644 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20645 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20646 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20647 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20648 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20649 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20650 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20651
20652 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20653 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20654 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20655 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20656 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20657 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020658 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020659 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20660
20661 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20662 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20663 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20664 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20665 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20666 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020667 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020668 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20669 occurs.
20670
20671 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
20672 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
20673 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
20674 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
20675 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
20676 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
20677 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
20678 cookies" below for more details.
20679
20680 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
20681 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
20682 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
20683 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
20684 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
20685 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
20686 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
20687 and cookies" below for more details.
20688
20689 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
20690 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
20691 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
20692 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
20693 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
20694 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
20695 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
20696 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
20697
20698
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200206998.2.4. Custom log format
20700------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020701
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020702The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020703mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020704
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020705HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020706Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
20707separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
20708prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
20709
20710Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
20711variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020712("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020713
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020714If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020020715as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020716less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
20717the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
20718
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020020719Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
20720"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
20721delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
20722preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020723
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020724Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
20725'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
20726https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
20727such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
20728
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020729Flags are :
20730 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020731 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020732 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
20733 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020734
20735 Example:
20736
20737 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
20738 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
20739
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020740 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
20741
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020742At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
20743
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020744 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
20745 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020746
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020747the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020748
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020749 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
20750 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
20751 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020752
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020753and the default TCP format is defined this way :
20754
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020755 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
20756 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020757
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020758Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
20759
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020760 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020761 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020762 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
20763 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
20764 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020765 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
20766 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
20767 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020768 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020769 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000020770 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000020771 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000020772 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020773 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
20774 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010020775 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020020776 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020777 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Christopher Faulet3f177162021-12-03 10:48:36 +010020778 | H | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020779 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020020780 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080020781 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020782 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
20783 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
20784 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
20785 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
20786 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020787 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020788 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020789 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020790 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020791 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020792 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
20793 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020794 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20795 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
20796 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020797 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020798 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
20799 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020800 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020801 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20802 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
20803 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020020804 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020020805 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020020806 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
20807 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
20808 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
20809 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020020810 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020811 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020812 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020813 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010020814 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020815 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020816 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
20817 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
20818 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020819 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020820 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
20821 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020822 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020823 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
20824 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020020825 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020826 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020827 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020828 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020829
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020830 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020831
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020832
208338.2.5. Error log format
20834-----------------------
20835
20836When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020837protocol header, HAProxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020838By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
20839"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020840will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020841logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
20842
20843The format looks like this :
20844
20845 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
20846 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
20847 Connection error during SSL handshake
20848
20849 Field Format Extract from the example above
20850 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
20851 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
20852 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
20853 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
20854 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
20855
20856These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
20857failures.
20858
20859
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208608.3. Advanced logging options
20861-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020862
20863Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
20864just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
20865options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
20866for more information about their usage.
20867
20868
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208698.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
20870------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020871
20872It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020873HAProxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020874commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
20875monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
20876ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
20877
20878 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
20879 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
20880 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
20881 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
20882
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020020883 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
20884 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020885
20886 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
20887 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
20888 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
20889
20890
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208918.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
20892----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020893
20894The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
20895what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
20896or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020897"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020898just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
20899log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
20900after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
20901is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
20902with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
20903with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
20904
20905
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209068.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
20907------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020908
20909Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
20910for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
20911"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
20912retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
20913raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
20914a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
20915file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
20916you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
20917"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
20918
20919
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209208.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
20921--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020922
20923Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
20924multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
20925them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
20926"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
20927logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
20928error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
20929and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
20930too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
20931useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
20932alternative.
20933
20934
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209358.4. Timing events
20936------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020937
20938Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
20939reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
20940the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
20941frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020942mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
20943addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
20944
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020945Timings events in HTTP mode:
20946
20947 first request 2nd request
20948 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
20949 t tr t tr ...
20950 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
20951 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
20952 :<---- Tq ---->: :
20953 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020954 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020955 :<--------- Ta --------->:
20956
20957Timings events in TCP mode:
20958
20959 TCP session
20960 |<----------------->|
20961 t t
20962 ---|----|----|----|----|---
20963 | Th Tw Tc Td |
20964 |<------ Tt ------->|
20965
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020966 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020967 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020968 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
20969 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
20970 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020971 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020972 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
20973 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
20974 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
20975 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020976
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020977 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
20978 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
20979 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020980 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
20981 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
20982 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
20983 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
20984 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
20985 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020986
20987 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
20988 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
20989 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
20990 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
20991 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
20992 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
20993 request typed by hand during a test.
20994
20995 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
20996 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020997 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020998 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
20999 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
21000 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
21001 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021002
21003 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
21004 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
21005 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
21006 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
21007 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
21008
21009 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
21010 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
21011 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
21012 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
21013 connection never established.
21014
21015 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
21016 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
21017 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
21018 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
21019 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
21020 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
21021 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
21022 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
21023 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
21024 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
21025 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
21026
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021027 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
21028 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
21029 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
21030 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
21031 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
21032 by subtracting other timers when valid :
21033
21034 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
21035
21036 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
21037 "Ta" can never be negative.
21038
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021039 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
21040 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021041 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
21042 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021043 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021044
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021045 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021046
21047 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021048 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
21049 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021050
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000021051 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
21052 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
21053 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
21054 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
21055 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
21056 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
21057 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
21058 prefixed with a '+' sign.
21059
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021060These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
21061protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
21062that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021063due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
21064"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
21065that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021066
21067Most common cases :
21068
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021069 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
21070 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
21071 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
21072 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
21073 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021074 ended, HAProxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021075 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
21076 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
21077 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
21078 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
21079 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020021080 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021081
21082 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
21083 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
21084 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
21085 of ms on remote networks.
21086
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021087 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
21088 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
21089 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021090
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021091 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
21092 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021093 HAProxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021094 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
21095 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
21096 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
21097 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
21098 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
21099 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021100
21101Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
21102
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021103 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021104 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021105 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021106
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021107 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021108 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
21109 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
21110
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021111 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021112 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
21113 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
21114 flags.
21115
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021116 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
21117 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021118 Check the session termination flags, then check the
21119 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
21120 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
21121 the client connection was maintained open.
21122
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021123 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021124 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021125 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021126 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
21127
21128
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200211298.5. Session state at disconnection
21130-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021131
21132TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
21133"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
211342-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
21135each of which has a special meaning :
21136
21137 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
21138 session to terminate :
21139
21140 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
21141
21142 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
21143 server explicitly refused it.
21144
21145 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
21146 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
21147 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
21148 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021149 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021150
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021151 L : the session was locally processed by HAProxy and was not passed to
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021152 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021153
21154 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
21155 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
21156 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
21157 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
21158 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
21159
21160 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
21161 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
21162 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
21163 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
21164 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
21165
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021166 D : the session was killed by HAProxy because the server was detected
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090021167 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
21168
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021169 U : the session was killed by HAProxy on this backup server because an
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070021170 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
21171 backup connections when going up.
21172
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021173 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020021174
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021175 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
21176 send or receive data.
21177
21178 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
21179 send or receive data.
21180
21181 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
21182 with nothing left in the buffers.
21183
21184 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
21185
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010021186 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021187 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
21188
21189 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
21190 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
21191 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
21192 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
21193 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
21194
21195 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
21196 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
21197
21198 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
21199 server (HTTP only).
21200
21201 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
21202
21203 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
21204 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
21205 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
21206
21207 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
21208 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
21209 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
21210
21211 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
21212
21213 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
21214 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
21215
21216 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
21217 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
21218 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
21219
21220 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
21221 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020021222 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
21223 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021224
21225 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
21226 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
21227 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
21228 another server.
21229
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021230 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021231 server.
21232
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021233 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
21234 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
21235 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
21236 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21237
21238 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
21239 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
21240 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
21241 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21242
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020021243 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
21244 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
21245 "use-server" rule).
21246
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021247 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21248
21249 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
21250 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
21251
21252 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
21253
21254 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
21255 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
21256 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
21257
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021258 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
21259 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021260 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021261 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
21262 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
21263
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021264 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
21265
21266 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
21267 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
21268
21269 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
21270
21271 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21272
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021273The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
21274was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021275helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
21276starvation, attacks, etc...
21277
21278The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
21279alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
21280easier finding and understanding.
21281
21282 Flags Reason
21283
21284 -- Normal termination.
21285
21286 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021287 server. This can happen when HAProxy tries to connect to a recently
21288 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while HAProxy is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021289 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
21290
21291 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
21292 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021293 client and HAProxy which decided to actively break the connection,
21294 by network routing issues between the client and HAProxy, or by a
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021295 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
21296 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021297
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021298 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21299 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021300 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021301
21302 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
21303 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
21304 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
21305
21306 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
21307 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
21308 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
21309 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
21310 the server takes too long to respond.
21311
21312 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
21313 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
21314 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
21315 long a time to respond.
21316
21317 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
21318 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
21319 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021320 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between HAProxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021321 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
21322 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021323
21324 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
21325 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
21326 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
21327 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
21328 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020021329 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021330 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
21331 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
21332 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
21333 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
21334 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
21335 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
21336 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
21337 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021338 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021339 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
21340 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
21341 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021342
21343 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
21344 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021345 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
21346 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
21347 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
21348 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021349
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021350 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. Generally
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021351 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
21352
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021353 SC The server or an equipment between it and HAProxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021354 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
21355 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021356 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021357 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
21358 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
21359
21360 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
21361 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
21362 503 or 504 here.
21363
21364 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021365 transfer. This usually means that HAProxy has received an RST from
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021366 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
21367 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
21368 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
21369
21370 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21371 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021372 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021373 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021374 between the client and the server expiring first on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021375
21376 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
21377 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
21378 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
21379 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
21380 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
21381 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021382 between HAProxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021383
21384 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
21385 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
21386 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
21387 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
21388 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
21389 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
21390 solution is to fix the application.
21391
21392 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
21393 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
21394 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
21395 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
21396 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
21397 external attacks.
21398
21399 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070021400 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021401 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021402 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
21403 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
21404
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021405 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
21406 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
21407 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021408 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020021409 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021410
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021411 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
21412 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
21413 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
21414 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021415 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
21416 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
21417 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
21418 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
Christopher Fauletae72ae42022-05-05 12:27:07 +020021419 logs. Finally, it may be due to an HTTP header rewrite failure on the
21420 response. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is sent (see
21421 "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-response strict-mode" for more
21422 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021423
21424 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
21425 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
21426 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
Christopher Fauletae72ae42022-05-05 12:27:07 +020021427 returned an HTTP 403 error. It may also be due to an HTTP header
21428 rewrite failure on the request. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is
21429 sent (see "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-request strict-mode" for more
21430 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021431
21432 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
21433 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
21434 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
21435 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
21436
21437 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
21438 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
21439 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
21440 only be solved by proper system tuning.
21441
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021442The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021443persistence was handled by the client, the server and by HAProxy. This is very
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021444important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
21445re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
21446
21447 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
21448
21449 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21450 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
21451 set on a GET request.
21452
21453 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
21454 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021455 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021456 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
21457
21458 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
21459 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
21460 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
21461
21462 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21463 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
21464 already got a cookie.
21465
21466 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21467 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
21468 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
21469 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
21470 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
21471
21472 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21473 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21474 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21475
21476 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
21477 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21478 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21479
21480 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
21481 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
21482
21483 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
21484 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
21485 then advertised in the response.
21486
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021487
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214888.6. Non-printable characters
21489-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021490
21491In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
21492consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
21493converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
21494prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
21495being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
21496escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
21497is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
21498'}' when logging headers.
21499
21500Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
21501issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
21502containing spaces is "User-Agent".
21503
21504Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
21505the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
21506performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
21507
21508
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200215098.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
21510---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021511
21512Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
21513achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021514section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021515cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
21516the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
21517the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021518locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021519not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
21520user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
21521a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
21522wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
21523
21524 Examples :
21525 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
21526 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
21527
21528 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
21529 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
21530
21531
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200215328.8. Capturing HTTP headers
21533---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021534
21535Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
21536proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
21537the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
21538server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
21539
21540Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
21541response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021542section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021543
21544It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021545time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
21546appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021547are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
21548and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
21549follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
21550request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
21551in the logs.
21552
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020021553As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
21554frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
21555an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
21556
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021557 Example :
21558 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
21559 listen proxy-out
21560 mode http
21561 option httplog
21562 option logasap
21563 log global
21564 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
21565
21566 # log the name of the virtual server
21567 capture request header Host len 20
21568
21569 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
21570 capture request header Content-Length len 10
21571
21572 # log the beginning of the referrer
21573 capture request header Referer len 20
21574
21575 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
21576 capture response header Server len 20
21577
21578 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
21579 capture response header Content-Length len 10
21580
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021581 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021582 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
21583
21584 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
21585 capture response header Via len 20
21586
21587 # log the URL location during a redirection
21588 capture response header Location len 20
21589
21590 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
21591 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
21592 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21593 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
21594 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
21595
21596 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21597 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21598 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21599 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021600 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021601
21602 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21603 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21604 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21605 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
21606 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021607 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021608
21609
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200216108.9. Examples of logs
21611---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021612
21613These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
21614them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
21615reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
21616
21617 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
21618 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21619 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21620
21621 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
21622 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
21623
21624 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
21625 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
21626 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21627
21628 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
21629 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
21630
21631 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
21632 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21633 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
21634
21635 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021636 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021637 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
21638 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
21639
21640 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
21641 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
21642 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
21643
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021644 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
21645 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
21646 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
21647 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021648 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was HAProxy who decided to
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021649 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021650
21651 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021652 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021653
21654 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
21655 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
21656 Nothing was sent to any server.
21657
21658 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
21659 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
21660
21661 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
21662 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021663 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021664 send a 408 return code to the client.
21665
21666 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
21667 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
21668
21669 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
21670 5 seconds ("c----").
21671
21672 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
21673 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021674 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021675
21676 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021677 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021678 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
21679 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
21680 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
21681 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
21682 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010021683
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020021684
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200216859. Supported filters
21686--------------------
21687
21688Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
21689accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
21690unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
21691
21692See also : "filter"
21693
216949.1. Trace
21695----------
21696
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010021697filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021698
21699 Arguments:
21700 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
21701 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
21702
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010021703 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021704
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021705 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021706 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
21707 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
21708 amount of the parsed data.
21709
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021710 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010021711
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021712This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
21713callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
21714information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
21715filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
21716
21717Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
21718tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
21719a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
21720
21721
217229.2. HTTP compression
21723---------------------
21724
21725filter compression
21726
21727The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
21728keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021729when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
21730fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
21731done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
21732explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
21733filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
21734listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21735order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021736
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021737See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
21738 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021739
21740
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200217419.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
21742--------------------------------------------
21743
21744filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
21745
21746 Arguments :
21747
21748 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
21749 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
21750 parsed.
21751
21752 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
21753 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
21754 part must be placed in its own scope.
21755
21756The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
21757external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021758streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021759exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
21760also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
21761
21762SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
21763the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
21764
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010021765For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021766"doc/SPOE.txt".
21767
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100217689.4. Cache
21769----------
21770
21771filter cache <name>
21772
21773 Arguments :
21774
21775 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
21776
21777The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
21778"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021779cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021780other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
21781case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
21782is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
21783filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010021784listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21785order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010021786
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021787See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
21788 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
21789
21790
217919.5. Fcgi-app
21792-------------
21793
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021794filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021795
21796 Arguments :
21797
21798 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
21799
21800The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
21801request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
21802reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
21803used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
21804implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
21805used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
21806fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
21807used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21808order.
21809
21810See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
21811 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
21812
21813
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100218149.6. OpenTracing
21815----------------
21816
21817The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
21818HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
21819of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
21820Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
21821
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021822This feature is only enabled when HAProxy was built with USE_OT=1.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010021823
21824The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
21825HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
21826participates in the work of HAProxy.
21827
21828filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
21829
21830 Arguments :
21831
21832 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
21833 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
21834 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
21835 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
21836 OpenTracing filters.
21837
21838 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
21839 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
21840 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
21841 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
21842 filter must have its own scope defined.
21843
21844More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020021845of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010021846
21847
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002184810. FastCGI applications
21849-------------------------
21850
21851HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
21852feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
21853the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
21854FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
21855servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
21856FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
21857backend.
21858
21859HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
21860application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
21861connection.
21862
2186310.1. Setup
21864-----------
21865
2186610.1.1. Fcgi-app section
21867--------------------------
21868
21869fcgi-app <name>
21870 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
21871 document root must be defined.
21872
21873acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
21874 Declare or complete an access list.
21875
21876 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
21877 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
21878 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
21879 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
21880 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
21881
21882docroot <path>
21883 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
21884 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
21885 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
21886
21887index <script-name>
21888 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
21889 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
21890 is an optional setting.
21891
21892 Example :
21893 index index.php
21894
21895log-stderr global
21896log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010021897 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021898 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
21899
21900 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
21901 default STDERR messages are ignored.
21902
21903pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21904 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
21905 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
21906 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21907
21908 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
21909 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
21910 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
21911 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
21912
21913 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
21914 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
21915
21916path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021917 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021918 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
21919 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
21920 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
21921 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
21922 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
21923 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
21924 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021925
21926 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021927 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021928 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
21929 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
21930 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
21931 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021932
21933 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021934 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
21935 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021936
21937option get-values
21938no option get-values
21939 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
21940
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021941 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021942 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
21943
21944 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
21945 application will accept.
21946
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020021947 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
21948 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021949
21950 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050021951 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021952 option is disabled.
21953
21954 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
21955 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
21956 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
21957 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
21958 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
21959 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
21960
21961option keep-conn
21962no option keep-conn
21963 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
21964 sending a response.
21965
21966 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
21967 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
21968
21969option max-reqs <reqs>
21970 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
21971 accept.
21972
21973 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
21974 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
21975 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
21976 to 1.
21977
21978option mpxs-conns
21979no option mpxs-conns
21980 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
21981
21982 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
21983 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
21984
21985set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21986 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
21987 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
21988 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
21989 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21990
21991 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
21992 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
21993 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
21994
21995 Example :
21996 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
21997 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
21998
21999 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
22000
22001
2200210.1.2. Proxy section
22003---------------------
22004
22005use-fcgi-app <name>
22006 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
22007
22008 Arguments :
22009 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
22010
22011 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
22012 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
22013 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
22014 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
22015 application may be defined at a time per backend.
22016
22017 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
22018 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
22019 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
22020 application are evaluated.
22021
22022
2202310.1.3. Example
22024---------------
22025
22026 frontend front-http
22027 mode http
22028 bind *:80
22029 bind *:
22030
22031 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
22032 default_backend back-static
22033
22034 backend back-static
22035 mode http
22036 server www A.B.C.D:80
22037
22038 backend back-dynamic
22039 mode http
22040 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
22041 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
22042
22043 fcgi-app php-fpm
22044 log-stderr global
22045 option keep-conn
22046
22047 docroot /var/www/my-app
22048 index index.php
22049 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
22050
22051
2205210.2. Default parameters
22053------------------------
22054
22055A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
22056the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022057script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022058applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
22059
22060 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22061 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
22062 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
22063 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
22064 | | |
22065 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22066 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
22067 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
22068 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
22069 | | application. |
22070 | | |
22071 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22072 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
22073 | | the request. It may not be set. |
22074 | | |
22075 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22076 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
22077 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
22078 | | the application's configuration. |
22079 | | |
22080 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22081 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
22082 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
22083 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
22084 | | |
22085 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22086 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
22087 | | following the part that identifies the script |
22088 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
22089 | | be defined. |
22090 | | |
22091 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22092 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
22093 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
22094 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
22095 | | is not set too. |
22096 | | |
22097 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22098 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
22099 | | set. |
22100 | | |
22101 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22102 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
22103 | | the request. |
22104 | | |
22105 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22106 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
22107 | | client as part of user authentication. |
22108 | | |
22109 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22110 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
22111 | | script to process the request. |
22112 | | |
22113 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22114 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
22115 | | |
22116 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22117 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
22118 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
22119 | | |
22120 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22121 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
22122 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
22123 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
22124 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
22125 | | |
22126 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22127 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
22128 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
22129 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
22130 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
22131 | | side. |
22132 | | |
22133 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22134 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
22135 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
22136 | | connected to. |
22137 | | |
22138 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22139 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
22140 | | |
22141 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb2a50292021-06-11 13:34:42 +020022142 | SERVER_SOFTWARE | Contains the string "HAProxy" followed by the |
22143 | | current HAProxy version. |
22144 | | |
22145 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022146 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
22147 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
22148 | | |
22149 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22150
22151
2215210.3. Limitations
22153------------------
22154
22155The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
22156way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
22157during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
22158establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
22159application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
22160or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
22161message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
22162these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
22163and HTTP servers under the same backend.
22164
22165Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
22166request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
22167requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
22168
22169About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
22170into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
22171fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
22172"http-request" ones.
22173
22174Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
22175FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
22176processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
22177must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
22178here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010022179
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022180
2218111. Address formats
22182-------------------
22183
22184Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
22185address.
22186
22187This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
22188The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
22189of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
22190equivalent is '::'.
22191
22192Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
22193is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
22194
22195This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
22196family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
22197
22198Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
22199configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
22200use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
22201'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
22202
22203Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
22204socket type and the transport method.
22205
22206
Daniel Corbette95f3072023-01-17 18:32:31 -05002220711.1. Address family prefixes
22208-----------------------------
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022209
22210'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
22211
22212'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
22213 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
22214 listening.
22215
22216'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
22217 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
22218 on the statement using this address, a port or
22219 a port range may or must be specified.
22220
22221'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22222 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
22223 using this address, a port or a port range
22224 may or must be specified.
22225
22226'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22227 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
22228 using this address, a port or a port range
22229 may or must be specified.
22230
22231'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
22232 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
22233 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
22234 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
22235 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
22236 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
22237
22238'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
22239 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
22240 start by slash '/'.
22241
22242
Daniel Corbette95f3072023-01-17 18:32:31 -05002224311.2. Socket type prefixes
22244--------------------------
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022245
22246Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
22247type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
22248this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
22249This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
22250but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
22251
22252Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should
Willy Tarreaudc2b3f82023-01-16 12:07:12 +010022253instead use aliases of the next section "11.3 Protocol prefixes".
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022254
22255If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
22256they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
22257report this to the maintainers.
22258
22259'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22260 to "stream"
22261
22262'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22263 to "datagram".
22264
22265
Daniel Corbette95f3072023-01-17 18:32:31 -05002226611.3. Protocol prefixes
22267-----------------------
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022268
22269'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22270 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22271 socket type and transport method is forced to
22272 "stream". Depending on the statement using
22273 this address, a port or a port range can or
22274 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22275 of 'stream+ip@'.
22276
22277'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22278 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22279 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22280 statement using this address, a port or port
22281 range can or must be specified.
22282 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22283
22284'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22285 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22286 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22287 statement using this address, a port or port
22288 range can or must be specified.
22289 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22290
22291'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22292 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22293 socket type and transport method is forced to
22294 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
22295 this address, a port or a port range can or
22296 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22297 of 'dgram+ip@'.
22298
22299'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22300 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22301 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22302 the statement using this address, a port or
22303 port range can or must be specified.
Willy Tarreau26460482023-01-16 12:11:38 +010022304 It is considered as an alias of 'dgram+ipv4@'.
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022305
22306'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22307 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22308 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22309 the statement using this address, a port or
22310 port range can or must be specified.
Willy Tarreau26460482023-01-16 12:11:38 +010022311 It is considered as an alias of 'dgram+ipv4@'.
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022312
22313'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22314 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
22315 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
22316
22317'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22318 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
22319 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
22320
22321In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
22322QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
22323
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010022324/*
22325 * Local variables:
22326 * fill-column: 79
22327 * End:
22328 */